blob: 9dbe432084d89761606dd924347678b8433caf98 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1c0a7222020-11-05 17:04:53 +01007 2020/11/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
407 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
408 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
409 "frontend" and "backend".
410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100411The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
412referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200413delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200415
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004162.2. Quoting and escaping
417-------------------------
418
419HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
420many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
421with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
422single quotes.
423
424If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
425them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
426escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
427
428Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
429
430 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
431 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
432 \\ to use a backslash
433 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
434 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
435
436Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
437the interpretation of:
438
439 space as a parameter separator
440 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
441 # hash as a comment start
442
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200443Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
444-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
445backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
446
447Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200448quoting.
449
450Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
451nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
452
453Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
454equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
455
456 Example:
457 # those are equivalents:
458 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
459 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
460 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
462 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
463
464 # those are equivalents:
465 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
468 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
469
470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004712.3. Environment variables
472--------------------------
473
474HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
475interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
476configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
477optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
478shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200479underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
480list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
481arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
482before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200483
484 Example:
485
486 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
487
488 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
489
490 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
491
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200492Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
493file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200494
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200495* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
496 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
497
498* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
499 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
500 directory.
501
502* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
503
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500504* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200505 processes, separated by semicolons.
506
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500507* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200508 CLI, separated by semicolons.
509
510See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200511
5122.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200513----------------
514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100515Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100516values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
517otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
518numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
519for every keyword. Supported units are :
520
521 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
522 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
523 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
524 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
525 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
526 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
527
528
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005292.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200530-------------
531
532 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
533 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
534 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
535 global
536 daemon
537 maxconn 256
538
539 defaults
540 mode http
541 timeout connect 5000ms
542 timeout client 50000ms
543 timeout server 50000ms
544
545 frontend http-in
546 bind *:80
547 default_backend servers
548
549 backend servers
550 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
551
552
553 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
554 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
555 global
556 daemon
557 maxconn 256
558
559 defaults
560 mode http
561 timeout connect 5000ms
562 timeout client 50000ms
563 timeout server 50000ms
564
565 listen http-in
566 bind *:80
567 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
568
569
570Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
571
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100572 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200573
574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005753. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576--------------------
577
578Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
579are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
580of them have command-line equivalents.
581
582The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
583
584 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200585 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - description
591 - deviceatlas-json-file
592 - deviceatlas-log-level
593 - deviceatlas-separator
594 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900595 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 - gid
597 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100598 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200599 - h1-case-adjust
600 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100601 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100602 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100603 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200604 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200615 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200676 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200677 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200678 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200679 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100680 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200681 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200682 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200683 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100684 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100686 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100687 - tune.lua.session-timeout
688 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200689 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100690 - tune.maxaccept
691 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200692 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200693 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200694 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200695 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
696 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.rcvbuf.client
698 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100699 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200700 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200701 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100702 - tune.sndbuf.client
703 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100704 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200705 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100706 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200707 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100708 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200709 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200710 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100711 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200712 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100713 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200714 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
715 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
716 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100717 - tune.zlib.memlevel
718 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200722 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726------------------------------------
727
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728ca-base <dir>
729 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100730 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
731 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
732 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734chroot <jail dir>
735 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
736 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
737 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
738 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
739 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100741
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
743 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
744 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
745 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
746 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
747 set. These sets have the format
748
749 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
750
751 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
754 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
756 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100758 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100760 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
762 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
763 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
764 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100765
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100766 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
767 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
768 on the machine's word size.
769
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100771 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
772 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
773 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
774 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
775 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
776 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777
778 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100779 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
782 # first 4 CPUs
783
784 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
785 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
786 # word size.
787
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100788 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100794 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
795 # and so on.
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
798 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100801 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
802 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
803 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
804
805 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
806 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
808
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100809 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
810 # and a thread range.
811 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
813 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
814
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200815crt-base <dir>
816 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100817 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
818 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820daemon
821 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
822 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100823 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
824 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826deviceatlas-json-file <path>
827 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829
830deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100831 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200832 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
833
834deviceatlas-separator <char>
835 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
836 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
837
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100838deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200839 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
840 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
841 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900843external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100844 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
845 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100846 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
847 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
848 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
849 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
850 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852gid <number>
853 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
854 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
855 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100856 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
857 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200858 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100859
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100860group <group name>
861 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
862 See also "gid" and "user".
863
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100864hard-stop-after <time>
865 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
866
867 Arguments :
868 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
869 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
870 SIGUSR1 signal.
871
872 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
873 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
874 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 hard-stop-after 30s
879
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
881 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
882 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
883 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
884 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500885 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200886 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
887 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
888 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
889 specified in a proxy.
890
891 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
892 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
893 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
894 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
895 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
896 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
897 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
898
899 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
900 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
901 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
902 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
903 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
904
905 Example:
906 global
907 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
908
909 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
910 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
911
912h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
913 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
914 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
915 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
916 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
917 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
918 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
919 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
920 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
921
922 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
923 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
924 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
925
926 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
927 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
928
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100929insecure-fork-wanted
930 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
931 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
932 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
933 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
934 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
935 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
936 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
937 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
938 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
939 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
940 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
941 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
942 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
943 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
944 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
945 disable it.
946
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100947insecure-setuid-wanted
948 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
949 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
950 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
951 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
952 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
953 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
954 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
955 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
956 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
957 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
958 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
959 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
960 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
961 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
962
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100963issuers-chain-path <dir>
964 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
965 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
966 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
967 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
968 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
969 "issuers-chain-path".
970 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
971 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
972 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
973 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
974 will share the chain in memory.
975
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200976localpeer <name>
977 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
978 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
979 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
980 the configuration parsing.
981
982 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
983 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
984
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200985log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
986 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100987 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989 configured with "log global".
990
991 <address> can be one of:
992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100993 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100994 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
995 port).
996
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100997 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
998 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
999 port).
1000
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001001 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1003 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001004 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001005
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001006 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1007 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1008 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1009 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1010 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1011 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1012 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1013 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1014 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1015 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1016 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1017 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1018 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1019 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001020 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1021 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001022
1023 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1024 "fd@2", see above.
1025
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001026 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1027 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1028 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1029 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1030 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1031
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001032 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1033 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001034
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001035 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1036 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1037 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1038 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1039 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1040 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1041 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1042 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1043 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1044 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001045 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1046 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001047
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001048 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1049 one of the following :
1050
1051 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1053
1054 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1055 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1056
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001057 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1058 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1059 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1060 designed to be used with a local log server.
1061
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001062 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1063 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1064 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1065 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1066 logger consumes.
1067
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001068 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1069 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1070 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1071 used with a local log server.
1072
1073 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1074 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1075 designed to be used with a local log server.
1076
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001077 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1078 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1079 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1080 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1081
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001082 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1083 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1084 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1085 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1086 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1087
1088 <sample_size>
1089 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1090 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1091 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1092 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1093 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1094
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001095 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001097 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1098 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1099 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1100
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001101 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1102 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1103 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1104 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001107 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1108 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1109 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1110 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1111 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1112 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001114 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001116log-send-hostname [<string>]
1117 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1118 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1119 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1120 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1121 the logs.
1122
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001123log-tag <string>
1124 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1125 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1126 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001127 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001128
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001129lua-load <file>
1130 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1131 used multiple times.
1132
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001133lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1134 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1135 variable.
1136 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1137 to "path".
1138
1139 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1140 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1141 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1142 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1143 will be checked earlier.
1144
1145 As an example by specifying the following path:
1146
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1148 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1149
1150 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1152 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1153 paths if that does not exist either.
1154
1155 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1156 documentation.
1157
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001158master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001159 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1160 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1161 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001162 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001163 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1164 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001165 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1166 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1167 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1168 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1169 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001170
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001171 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001172
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173mworker-max-reloads <number>
1174 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001175 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001176 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1177 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1178 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1179
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001180nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001181 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1182 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1183 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001184 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1185 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001186 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1187 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1188 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001190nbthread <number>
1191 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001192 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1193 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1194 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1195 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1196 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001197 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1198 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1199 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1200 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1201 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1202 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1203 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001204
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001205pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001206 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1207 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1208 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1209 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001210
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001211pp2-never-send-local
1212 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1213 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1214 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1215 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1216 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1217 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1218 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1219 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1220 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1221 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1222 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1223
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001224presetenv <name> <value>
1225 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1226 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1227 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1228 and "unsetenv".
1229
1230resetenv [<name> ...]
1231 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1232 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1233 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1234 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1235 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1236 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1237 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1238 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1239
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001240stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001241 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1242 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1243 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1244 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1245 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1246 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001247 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001248 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1249 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1250 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1251 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001252
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001253server-state-base <directory>
1254 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001255 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1256 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001257
1258server-state-file <file>
1259 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1260 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1261 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1262 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1263 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1264 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1265 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1266 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001267 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1268 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001269
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001270setenv <name> <value>
1271 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1272 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1273 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1274 and "unsetenv".
1275
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001276set-dumpable
1277 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001278 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1279 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1280 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1281 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1282 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1283 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1284 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1285 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1286 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1287 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1288 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1289 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1290 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1291 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1292 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1293 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1294 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001295
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001296ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1298 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001299 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001300 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001301 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1302 information and recommendations see e.g.
1303 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1304 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1305 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1306 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001307
1308ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1310 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1311 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1312 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1313 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001314 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1315 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1316 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001317 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001318
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001319ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1321 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1322 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1323 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1324 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1325
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001326ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1328 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1329 keyword to see available options.
1330
1331 Example:
1332 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001333 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001334
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001335ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1337 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001338 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001339 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001340 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1341 information and recommendations see e.g.
1342 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1343 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1344 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1345 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1346 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001347
1348ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1350 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1351 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1352 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1353 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001354 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1355 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1356 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1357 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001358
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001359ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1361 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1362 keyword to see available options.
1363
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001364ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1366 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1367 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001368 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001369 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001370 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1371 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1372 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1373 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001374 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1375 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1376 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1377
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001378ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1379 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1380 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001381 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001382 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001383 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1384
1385 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001386
1387 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1388 and won't try to remove them.
1389
1390 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1391
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001392ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001394 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1395 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001396
1397 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1398 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1399 optimize the startup time.
1400
1401 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1402 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1403 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1404
1405 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001406 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001407
1408 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001409 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1410
1411 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1412 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1413 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1414 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1415 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1416 bind configuration..
1417
1418 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1419 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1420 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1421 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1422 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1423 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1424 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1425 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1426
1427 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1428
1429 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1430 a cert bundle.
1431
1432 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1433 separately in several "crt".
1434
1435 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1436 since files are loading separately.
1437
1438 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1439 required to commit them.
1440
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001441 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001442 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001443
1444 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1445
1446 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1447
1448 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1449 not provided in the PEM file.
1450
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001451 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1452 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1453
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001454 The default behavior is "all".
1455
1456 Example:
1457 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1458 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1459 ssl-load-extra-files none
1460
1461 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1462
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001463ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1464 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1465 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1466 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1467
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001468ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001469 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001470 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1471 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1472 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1473 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1474 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1475 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001476 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001477
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001478stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1479 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1480 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1481 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001482 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001483 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001484
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001485 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1486 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1487 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001488
1489stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1490 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1491 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001492 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001493
1494stats maxconn <connections>
1495 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1496 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498uid <number>
1499 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1500 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1501 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1502 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1503
1504ulimit-n <number>
1505 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1506 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1507 option.
1508
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001509unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1510 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1511
1512 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1513 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1514 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1515 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1516 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1517 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1518 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1519 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1520 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1521 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1522
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001523unsetenv [<name> ...]
1524 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1525 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1526 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1527 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1528 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1529 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1530 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1531
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001532user <user name>
1533 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1534 See also "uid" and "group".
1535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001536node <name>
1537 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1538
1539 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1540 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1541 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1542 traffic.
1543
1544description <text>
1545 Add a text that describes the instance.
1546
1547 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1548 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1549 "<" and ">" characters.
1550
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100155151degrees-data-file <file path>
1552 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001553 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001554
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001556 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1557
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000155851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001559 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1560 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1561 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1562
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001563 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001564 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1565
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200156651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001567 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1568 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1569
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001570 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1571 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1572
157351degrees-cache-size <number>
1574 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1575 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1576 By default, this cache is disabled.
1577
1578 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001579 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1580
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001581wurfl-data-file <file path>
1582 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1583 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1584
1585 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1586 with USE_WURFL=1.
1587
1588wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1589 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1590 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1591 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1592
1593 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1594
1595 Valid WURFL properties are:
1596 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1597
1598 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1599 device.
1600
1601 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1602 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1603
1604 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1605 particular web request.
1606
1607 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1608 used Libwurfl API version.
1609
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001610 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1611 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1612
1613 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1614 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1615
1616 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1617
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001618 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1619 with USE_WURFL=1.
1620
1621wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1622 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1623 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1624
1625 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1626 with USE_WURFL=1.
1627
1628wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1629 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1630 thus before the chroot.
1631
1632 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1633 with USE_WURFL=1.
1634
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001635wurfl-cache-size <size>
1636 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1637 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001638 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001639 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001640
1641 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1642 with USE_WURFL=1.
1643
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001644strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001645 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1646 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1647 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1648 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1649 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001652-----------------------
1653
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001654busy-polling
1655 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1656 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1657 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1658 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1659 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1660 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1661 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1662 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1663 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1664 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1665 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1666 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1667 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1668 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1669 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1670 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1671 "poll" pollers.
1672
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001673 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1674 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1675 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1676
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001677max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1678 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1679 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1680 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1681 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1682 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1683 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1684 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1685 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687maxconn <number>
1688 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1689 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1690 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001691 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1692 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1693 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1694 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001695 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1696 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1697 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1698 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1699 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1700 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001702maxconnrate <number>
1703 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1704 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1705 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1706 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1707 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1708 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1709 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1710 fairness.
1711
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001712maxcomprate <number>
1713 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001715 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1716 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1717 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001718 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001719 default value.
1720
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001721maxcompcpuusage <number>
1722 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1723 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1724 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1725 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1726 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1727 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1728 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1729 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1730
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001731maxpipes <number>
1732 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1733 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1734 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1735 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1736 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1737 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1738
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001739maxsessrate <number>
1740 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1741 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1742 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1743 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1744 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1745 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1746 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1747 fairness.
1748
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001749maxsslconn <number>
1750 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1751 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1752 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1753 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1754 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1755 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1756 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001757 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1758 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1759 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1760 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1761 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1762 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1763 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001764
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001765maxsslrate <number>
1766 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1767 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1768 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1769 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1770 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1771 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1772 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1773 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1774 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1775 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1776
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001777maxzlibmem <number>
1778 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1779 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1780 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001781 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1782 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1783 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001785noepoll
1786 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1787 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001788 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001789
1790nokqueue
1791 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1792 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1793 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1794
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001795noevports
1796 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1797 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1798 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1799 also "nopoll".
1800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001801nopoll
1802 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1803 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001805 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1806 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001807
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001808nosplice
1809 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001811 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001812 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001813 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1814 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1815 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1816 "option splice-response".
1817
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001818nogetaddrinfo
1819 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1820 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1821
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001822noreuseport
1823 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1824 command line argument "-dR".
1825
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001826profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1827 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1828 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1829 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1830 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001831 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001832 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1833 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1834 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1835 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1836
1837 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1838 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1839 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1840 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1841 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001842 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1843 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1844 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1845 CLI.
1846
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001847spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001848 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1849 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1850 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1851 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1852 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1853 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001854
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001855ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001856 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001858 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1859 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1860 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1861 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1862 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1864 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001865 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1866 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1867 openssl configuration file uses:
1868 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1869
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001870ssl-mode-async
1871 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001872 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001873 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1874 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1875 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001877 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001878
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001879tune.buffers.limit <number>
1880 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1881 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1882 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1883 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1884 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001885 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001886 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1887 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1888 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1889 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1890 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1891 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1892 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1893 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1894 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1895
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001896tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1897 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1898 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1899 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1900 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1901
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001902tune.bufsize <number>
1903 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1904 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1905 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1906 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1907 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1908 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1909 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001910 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1911 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1912 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001913 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001914 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1915 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1916 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001917
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001918tune.chksize <number>
1919 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1920 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1921 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1922 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1923 checks whenever possible.
1924
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001925tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1926 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1927 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1928 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1929 this value. The default value is 1.
1930
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001931tune.fail-alloc
1932 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1933 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1934 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1935 gracefully.
1936
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001937tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1938 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1939 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1940 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1941 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1942 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1943
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001944tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1945 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1946 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1947 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1948 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1949 change it.
1950
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001951tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1952 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001953 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1954 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001955 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1956 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1957 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1958 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1959 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1960
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001961tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1962 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1963 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1964 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1965 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1966 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1967 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1968 recommended not to change this value.
1969
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001970tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1971 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1972 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1973 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1974 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1975 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1976 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1977 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1978
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001979tune.http.cookielen <number>
1980 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1981 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1982 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1983 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1984 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1985 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1986 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1987 to change this value.
1988
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001989tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1991 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001992 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001993 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001994 configuration directives too.
1995 The default value is 1024.
1996
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001997tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1998 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1999 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2000 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2001 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2002 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2003 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002004 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2005 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2006 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002007
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002008tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2009 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2010 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2011 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2012 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2013 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2014 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2015 this option to "off". The default is on.
2016
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017tune.idletimer <timeout>
2018 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2019 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2020 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2021 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2022 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2023 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002025 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002026 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2027
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002028tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2029 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2030 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2031 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2032 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2033 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2034 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2035 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2036 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2037 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2038
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002039tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2040 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002041 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002042 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2043 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002044 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002045 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2046 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2047
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002048tune.lua.maxmem
2049 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2050 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2051 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2052 memory.
2053
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002054tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2055 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002056 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2057 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002059
2060tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2061 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2062 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2063 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2064 check servers.
2065
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002066tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2067 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2068 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2069 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002070 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002071
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002072tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002073 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2074 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2075 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2076 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2077 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2078 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2079 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2080 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2081 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2082 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002083
2084tune.maxpollevents <number>
2085 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2086 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2087 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2088 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2089 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2090
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002091tune.maxrewrite <number>
2092 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2093 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2094 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2095 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2096 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2097 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2098 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2099 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2100 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2101 bufsize.
2102
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002103tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2104 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2105 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2106 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2107 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2108 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2109 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2110 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2111 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2112 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002113 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2114 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002115 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2116 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2117 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2118 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2119 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2120 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2121 setting this parameter to 0.
2122
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002123tune.pipesize <number>
2124 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2125 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2126 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2127 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2128 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2129 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2130
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002131tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2132 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2133 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2134 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2135 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2136 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2137 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002138 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002139
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002140tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2141 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2142 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2143 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2144 default is 20.
2145
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002146tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2147tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2148 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2149 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2150 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002151 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002152 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002153 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2154 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2155
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002156tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002157 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002158 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2159 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2160 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2161 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2162
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002163tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002164 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002165 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002166 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2167 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2168 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2169
2170tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2171 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2172 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2173 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2174 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2175 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2176 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2177 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2178 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2179 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002180
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002181tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2182tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2183 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2184 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2185 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002186 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002187 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002188 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2189 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2190 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2191 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2192 notifying haproxy again.
2193
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002194tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002195 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2196 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2197 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002198 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002199 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002200 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002201 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2202 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2203 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002204 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2205 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002206
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002207tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002208 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002209 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2210 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2211 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2212 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2213 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2214
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002215tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2216 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2217 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2218 performances. This is disabled by default.
2219
2220 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2221 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2222
2223 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2224
2225 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2226
2227 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2228
2229 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2230 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2231 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2232
2233 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2234 converted.
2235
2236 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2237 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2238 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2239 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2240 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2241 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2242 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002243 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2244 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002245
2246 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2247
2248 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2249 only need this line:
2250
2251 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2252
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002253tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2254 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002255 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002256 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2257 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2258 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2259 being used for too long.
2260
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002261tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2262 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2263 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2264 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2265 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2266 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2267 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2268 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2269 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2270 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2271 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002272 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002273 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002274
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002275tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2276 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2277 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2278 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2279 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002280 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002281 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2282 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002283 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2284 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002285
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002286tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2287 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2288 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2289 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2290 1000 entries.
2291
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002292tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2293 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2294 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2295 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2296
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002297tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002298tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002299tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2300tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2301tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002302 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2303 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2304 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2305 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2306 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2307 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2308 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2309 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002310
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002311 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2312 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2313 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2314 all available space is consumed.
2315 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2316 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2317 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2325
2326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023323.3. Debugging
2333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002335quiet
2336 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2337 line argument "-q".
2338
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002339zero-warning
2340 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2341 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2342 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2343 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2344 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2345 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2346
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023483.4. Userlists
2349--------------
2350It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2351http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2352it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2353
2354userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002355 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002356 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2357
2358group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002359 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002360 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2361 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2362
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002363user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2364 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002365 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2366 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002367 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2368 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2369 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2370 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002371
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002372 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2373 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2374 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2375 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2376 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2377 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2378 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2379 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2380 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002381
2382 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002383 userlist L1
2384 group G1 users tiger,scott
2385 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002386
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002387 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2388 user scott insecure-password elgato
2389 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002390
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002391 userlist L2
2392 group G1
2393 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002394
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002395 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2396 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2397 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002398
2399 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002400
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002401
24023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002403----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002404It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2405several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2406instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2407values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2408automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2409In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2410using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2411tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2412reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2413Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2414that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2415each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002416
2417peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002418 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002419 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2420
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002421bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2422 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2423 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2424
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002425disabled
2426 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2427 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2428 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2429
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002430default-bind [param*]
2431 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2432
2433default-server [param*]
2434 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2435
2436 Arguments:
2437 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2438 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2439 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2440 details.
2441
2442
2443 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2444
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002445enable
2446 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2447
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002448log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2449 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2450 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2451 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2452 more details.
2453
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002454peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002455 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2456 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002457 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2458 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2459 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2460 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2461 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002462
2463 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2464 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2465
2466 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002467 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2468 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2469 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2472 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002473
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002474 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2475 "server" keyword explanation below).
2476
2477server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002478 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002479 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2480 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2481 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2482 of this "peers" section).
2483 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2484
2485
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002486 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002487 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002488 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002489 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2490 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2491 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002492
2493 backend mybackend
2494 mode tcp
2495 balance roundrobin
2496 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2497 stick on src
2498
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002499 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2500 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002501
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002502 Example:
2503 peers mypeers
2504 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2505 default-server ssl verify none
2506 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2507 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002508
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002509
2510table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2511 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2512
2513 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2514 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002515 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002516 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2517 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2518 "stick-table" keyword).
2519
2520 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2521 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2522 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2523 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2524 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2525 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2526 of the stick-table name as follows:
2527
2528 peers mypeers
2529 peer A ...
2530 peer B ...
2531 table t1 ...
2532
2533 frontend fe1
2534 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2535
2536 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2537 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2538
2539 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2540 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2541 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2542 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2543 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2544 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2545 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2546
2547 peers mypeers
2548 peer A ...
2549 peer B ...
2550 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2551
2552 backend t1
2553 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2554
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002555 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002556 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2557 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2558
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025593.6. Mailers
2560------------
2561It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2562If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2563in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2564
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002565mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002566 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2567 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2568
2569mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2570 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2571
2572 Example:
2573 mailers mymailers
2574 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2575 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2576
2577 backend mybackend
2578 mode tcp
2579 balance roundrobin
2580
2581 email-alert mailers mymailers
2582 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2583 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2584
2585 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2586 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2587
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002588timeout mail <time>
2589 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2590 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2591 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2592 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2593
2594 Example:
2595 mailers mymailers
2596 timeout mail 20s
2597 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002598
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025993.7. Programs
2600-------------
2601In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2602master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2603managed the same way as the workers.
2604
2605During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2606sequence as a worker:
2607
2608 - the master is re-executed
2609 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2610 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2611 instance of the program
2612
2613During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2614
2615program <name>
2616 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2617 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2618 the management guide).
2619
2620command <command> [arguments*]
2621 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2622 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2623 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2624 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2625
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002626user <user name>
2627 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2628 See also "group".
2629
2630group <group name>
2631 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2632 See also "user".
2633
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002634option start-on-reload
2635no option start-on-reload
2636 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2637 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2638 program section.
2639
2640
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026413.8. HTTP-errors
2642----------------
2643
2644It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2645imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2646several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2647
2648http-errors <name>
2649 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2650 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2651
2652errorfile <code> <file>
2653 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2654
2655 Arguments :
2656 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002657 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2658 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002659
2660 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2661 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2662 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2663 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2664 before any chroot is performed.
2665
2666 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2667
2668 Example:
2669 http-errors website-1
2670 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2671 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2672 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2673
2674 http-errors website-2
2675 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2676 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2677 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2678
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026793.9. Rings
2680----------
2681
2682It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2683servers or traces.
2684
2685ring <ringname>
2686 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2687
2688description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002689 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002690 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2691
2692format <format>
2693 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2694
2695 Arguments:
2696 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2697 one of the following :
2698
2699 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2700 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2701 designed to be used with a local log server.
2702
2703 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2704 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2705 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2706 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2707 is the default.
2708
2709 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2711
2712 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2713 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2714
2715 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2716 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2717 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2718 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2719 logger consumes.
2720
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002721 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2722 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2723 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2724 with a local log server.
2725
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002726 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2727 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2728 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2729 used with a local log server.
2730
2731maxlen <length>
2732 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2733 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2734 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2735
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002736server <name> <address> [param*]
2737 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2738 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2739 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2740 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2741 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2742 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2743 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2744 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2745 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002746 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2747 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002748
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002749size <size>
2750 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2751 set to BUFSIZE.
2752
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002753timeout connect <timeout>
2754 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2755
2756 Arguments :
2757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2759 as explained at the top of this document.
2760
2761timeout server <timeout>
2762 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2763
2764 Arguments :
2765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2767 as explained at the top of this document.
2768
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002769 Example:
2770 global
2771 log ring@myring local7
2772
2773 ring myring
2774 description "My local buffer"
2775 format rfc3164
2776 maxlen 1200
2777 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002778 timeout connect 5s
2779 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002780 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002781
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027823.10. Log forwarding
2783-------------------
2784
2785It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2786haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2787
2788log-forward <name>
2789 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2790
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002791backlog <conns>
2792 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2793 on connections accept.
2794
2795bind <addr> [param*]
2796 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002797 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2798 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2799 syslog protocol over TCP.
2800 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002801 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2802
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002803dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002804 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2805 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2806 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2807 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002808 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002809
2810log global
2811log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2812 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2813 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2814 documentation.
2815 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2816 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2817 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2818 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2819 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2820
2821 Example:
2822 global
2823 log stderr format iso local7
2824
2825 ring myring
2826 description "My local buffer"
2827 format rfc5424
2828 maxlen 1200
2829 size 32764
2830 timeout connect 5s
2831 timeout server 10s
2832 # syslog tcp server
2833 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2834
2835 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002836 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2837 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002838 # all messages on stderr
2839 log global
2840 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2841 log ring@myring local0
2842 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2843 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2844 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2845 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2846 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002847
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002848maxconn <conns>
2849 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2850 10 is the default.
2851
2852timeout client <timeout>
2853 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028554. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002856----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002858Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002859 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002860 - frontend <name>
2861 - backend <name>
2862 - listen <name>
2863
2864A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2865its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2866section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002868
2869A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2870connections.
2871
2872A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2873to forward incoming connections.
2874
2875A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2876parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2879'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2880case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2881
2882Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2883logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2884proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2885However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2886name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2887
2888Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2889and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002890bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2892modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2893arbitrary criteria.
2894
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002895In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2896a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002897the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002898
2899 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2900 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2901 between responses and new requests.
2902
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002903 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2904 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2905 client-facing connection remains open.
2906
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002907 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2908 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002909
2910The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2911frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2912following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002913weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002914
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002915 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002916
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002917 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2918 ----+-----+-----+----
2919 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2920 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002921 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2922 ----+-----+-----+----
2923 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029274.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2928--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002930The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2931limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2932they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2933limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002934marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002935option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002936and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2937with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2938specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002940
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2942------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2943acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002944backlog X X X -
2945balance X - X X
2946bind - X X -
2947bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002948capture cookie - X X -
2949capture request header - X X -
2950capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002951clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2952clitcpka-idle X X X -
2953clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002954compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002956declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002957default-server X - X X
2958default_backend X X X -
2959description - X X X
2960disabled X X X X
2961dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002962email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002963email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002964email-alert mailers X X X X
2965email-alert myhostname X X X X
2966email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002967enabled X X X X
2968errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002969errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002970errorloc X X X X
2971errorloc302 X X X X
2972-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2973errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002974force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002975filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002976fullconn X - X X
2977grace X X X X
2978hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002979http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002980http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002981http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002982http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002983http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002984http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002985http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002986http-check set-var X - X X
2987http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002988http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002989http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002990http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002991http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002992http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002993id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002994ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002995load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002996log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002997log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002998log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002999log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003000max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001maxconn X X X -
3002mode X X X X
3003monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004monitor-uri X X X -
3005option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3006option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3007option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3008option allbackups (*) X - X X
3009option checkcache (*) X - X X
3010option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3011option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003012option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003013option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3014option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003015-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3016option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003017option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3018option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003019option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003020option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003021option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003022option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003023option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003024option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3025option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3026option httpchk X - X X
3027option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003028option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003029option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003030option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003031option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003032option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003033option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3034option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3035option logasap (*) X X X -
3036option mysql-check X - X X
3037option nolinger (*) X X X X
3038option originalto X X X X
3039option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003040option pgsql-check X - X X
3041option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003042option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003043option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003044option smtpchk X - X X
3045option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3046option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3047option splice-request (*) X X X X
3048option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003049option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3051option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3052-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003053option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003054option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3055option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3056option tcpka X X X X
3057option tcplog X X X X
3058option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003059external-check command X - X X
3060external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3062rate-limit sessions X X X -
3063redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003065retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003066retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003067server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003068server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003069server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003070source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003071srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3072srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3073srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003074stats admin - X X X
3075stats auth X X X X
3076stats enable X X X X
3077stats hide-version X X X X
3078stats http-request - X X X
3079stats realm X X X X
3080stats refresh X X X X
3081stats scope X X X X
3082stats show-desc X X X X
3083stats show-legends X X X X
3084stats show-node X X X X
3085stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003086-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3087stick match - - X X
3088stick on - - X X
3089stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003090stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003091stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003092tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003093tcp-check connect X - X X
3094tcp-check expect X - X X
3095tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003096tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003097tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003098tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003099tcp-check set-var X - X X
3100tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003101tcp-request connection - X X -
3102tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003103tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003104tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003105tcp-response content - - X X
3106tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003107timeout check X - X X
3108timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003109timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003110timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003111timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3112timeout http-request X X X X
3113timeout queue X - X X
3114timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003115timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003116timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003117timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003118transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003119unique-id-format X X X -
3120unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003121use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003122use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003123use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003124------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3125 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3129---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
3131This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3132
3133
3134acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3135 Declare or complete an access list.
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 no | yes | yes | yes
3138 Example:
3139 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3140 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3141 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
3145
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003146backlog <conns>
3147 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3149 yes | yes | yes | no
3150 Arguments :
3151 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3152 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003153 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003154
3155 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3156 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3157 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3158 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3159 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3160 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3161 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3162 backlog parameter.
3163
3164 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3165 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3166 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3167
3168 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3169
3170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003171balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003172balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003173 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3175 yes | no | yes | yes
3176 Arguments :
3177 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3178 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3179 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3180 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3181
3182 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3183 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3184 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3185 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003186 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003187 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003188 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3189 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3190 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3191 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3192 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3193 it, so that you don't worry.
3194
3195 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3196 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3197 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3198 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3199 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3200 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3201 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3202 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003204 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3205 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3206 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3207 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3208 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3209 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3210 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003211 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3212 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3213 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003214
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003215 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003216 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003217 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3218 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003219 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003220 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3221 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3222 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3223 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3224 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003225 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3226 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3227 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3228 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3229 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3230 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3233 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3234 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3235 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3236 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3237 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3238 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3239 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003240 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003242 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3243 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3244 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003246 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3247 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3248 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3249 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3250 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3251 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3252 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3253 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3254 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3255 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3256 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3257 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003258
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003259 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003260 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3261 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3262 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3263 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3264 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3265 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3266 URIs start with a leading "/".
3267
3268 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3269 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3270 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3271 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3272
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003273 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3274 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3275 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3276 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003279 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3280
3281 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003282 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3283 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003284 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3285 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3286 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3287 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003288 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003289 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3290 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003291
3292 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3293 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3294 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3295 server will receive the request.
3296
3297 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3298 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3299 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3300 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3301 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003302 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3303 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3304 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003305
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003306 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3307 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3308 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3309 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3310 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003312 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003313 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3314 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3315 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3316
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003317 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3318 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3319 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3320
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003321 random
3322 random(<draws>)
3323 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003324 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3325 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3326 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3327 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003328 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3329 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3330 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3331 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3332 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3333 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3334 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3335 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3336 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3337 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3338 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3339 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3340 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3341 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3342 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3343 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3344 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3345 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3346 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3347 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003348
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003349 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003350 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003351 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3352 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3353 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3354 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3355 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3356 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003357 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003358 used instead.
3359
3360 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3361 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3362 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3363 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3364
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003365 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3366 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3367 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3368
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003369 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003372 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3373 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003374
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003375 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3376 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3377 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003379 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003380 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003381 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3382 NTLM relies on.
3383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384 Examples :
3385 balance roundrobin
3386 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003387 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003388 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3389 balance hdr(host)
3390 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003391
3392 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3393 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003395 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003396 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3397 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3398 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003399 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003400
3401 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3402 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3403 defaults to 16 kB.
3404
3405 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3406 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3407
3408 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3409 Round Robin.
3410
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003411 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003412 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3413 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3414 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3415
3416 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3417
3418 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003419 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003420 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3421 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3422 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003423
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003424 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
3426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003427bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3428bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3431 no | yes | yes | no
3432 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003433 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3434 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3435 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3436 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003437 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003438 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3439 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3440 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3441 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3442 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3443 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003444 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003445 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3446 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003447 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003448 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3449 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003450 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003451 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3452 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003453 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003454 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3455 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3456 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3457 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3458 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3459 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3460 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003461 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3462 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3463 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003464 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3465 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3466 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3467 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3469 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3470 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003471
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003472 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3473 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003474 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3475 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3476 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003477 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3478 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3479 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3480 the range.
3481
3482 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3483 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3484 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3485 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3486 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3487 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3488 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003489 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003490 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003492 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003493 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003494 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3495 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3496 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3497 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3498 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3499 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003501 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3502 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3503 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3504 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003506 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3507 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3508 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3509 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3510 in a frontend.
3511
3512 Example :
3513 listen http_proxy
3514 bind :80,:443
3515 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003516 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003518 listen http_https_proxy
3519 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003520 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003521
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003522 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3523 bind ipv6@:80
3524 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3525 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3526
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003527 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003528 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003529
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003530 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3531 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3532 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3533 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3534 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3535
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003536 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003537 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538
3539
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003540bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003541 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | yes | yes | yes
3544 Arguments :
3545 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3546 may be used to override a default value.
3547
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003548 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003549 option may be combined with other numbers.
3550
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003551 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003552 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3553 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3554 missing from all processes.
3555
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003556 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003557 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003558 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3559 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3560 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3561 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3562 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003563 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003564
3565 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3566 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3567 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3568 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3569 and 'even' instances.
3570
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003571 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3572 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3573 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3574 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003575
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003576 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3577 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3578
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003579 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3580 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3581 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3582
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003583 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3584 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3585
3586 Example :
3587 listen app_ip1
3588 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003589 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003590
3591 listen app_ip2
3592 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003593 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003594
3595 listen management
3596 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003597 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003598
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003599 listen management
3600 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3601 bind-process 1-4
3602
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003603 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003604
3605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606capture cookie <name> len <length>
3607 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 no | yes | yes | no
3610 Arguments :
3611 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3612 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3613 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3614 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003615 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616
3617 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3618 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3619 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3620 right if it exceeds <length>.
3621
3622 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3623 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3624 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3625 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3626
3627 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3628 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3629 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3630
3631 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3632 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3633 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003634 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3635 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3636 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003637
3638 Example:
3639 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3640
3641 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003642 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003643
3644
3645capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003646 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 no | yes | yes | no
3649 Arguments :
3650 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003651 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3653 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3654 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3655
3656 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3657 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3658 it exceeds <length>.
3659
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003660 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3662 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003663 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3664 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3665 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3666 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003667 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003668 environments to find where the request came from.
3669
3670 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3671 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3672 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3673 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003675 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3676 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3677 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3678 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3679 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680
3681 Example:
3682 capture request header Host len 15
3683 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003684 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003686 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 about logging.
3688
3689
3690capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003691 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 no | yes | yes | no
3694 Arguments :
3695 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003696 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3698 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3699 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3700
3701 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3702 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3703 it exceeds <length>.
3704
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003705 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3707 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3708 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003709 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3710 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3711 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3712 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003713
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003714 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3715 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3716 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3717 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3718 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719
3720 Example:
3721 capture response header Content-length len 9
3722 capture response header Location len 15
3723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003724 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725 about logging.
3726
3727
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003728clitcpka-cnt <count>
3729 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3730 the connection on the client side.
3731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | yes | yes | no
3733 Arguments :
3734 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3735
3736 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3737 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003738 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3739 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003740
3741 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3742
3743
3744clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3745 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3746 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3747 client side.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | no
3750 Arguments :
3751 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3752 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3753 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3754 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3755
3756 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3757 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003758 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3759 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003760
3761 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3762
3763
3764clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3765 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3767 yes | yes | yes | no
3768 Arguments :
3769 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3770 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3771 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3772 document.
3773
3774 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3775 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003776 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3777 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003778
3779 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3780
3781
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003782compression algo <algorithm> ...
3783compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003784compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003785 Enable HTTP compression.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003789 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3790 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3791 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3792
3793 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003794 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3795 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3796 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003797
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003798 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003799 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003800
3801 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3802 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3803 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3804 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3805 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003806 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003807
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003808 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3809 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3810 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3811 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3812 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3813 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3814 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003815 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003816
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003817 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003818 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003819 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3820 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3821 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3822 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3823 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003824
3825 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3826 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3827 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3828 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3829 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003830 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3831 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3832 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3833 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3834 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003835 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3836 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003837
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003838 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003839 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3840 "Accept-Encoding" header
3841 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003842 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003843 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3844 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3845 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3846 "multipart"
3847 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3848 header
3849 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3850 and later
3851 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3852 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003853 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003854
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003855 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003856
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003857 Examples :
3858 compression algo gzip
3859 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003860
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003861
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003862cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003863 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3864 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003865 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003866 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | no | yes | yes
3869 Arguments :
3870 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3871 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3872 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3873 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3874 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3875 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003876 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3878 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3879
3880 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3881 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3882 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3883 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3884 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3885 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003886 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3887 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003888 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003889 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3890 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003891
3892 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003893 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003894
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003895 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003896 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003897 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003898 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003899 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3900 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3901 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3902 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3903 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3904 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3905 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003906
3907 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3908 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3909 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3910 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3911 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3912 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3913 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3914 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3915 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003916 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003917 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3918 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3919 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003921 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3922 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3923 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003924 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3925 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3926 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3927 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003928 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3929 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3930 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
3932 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3933 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3934 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3935 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3936 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3937 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3938 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3939 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3940 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3941
3942 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3943 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3944 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3945 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3946 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3947 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3948 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3949 persistence cookie in the cache.
3950 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3951
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003952 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3953 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3954 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3955 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3956 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003957 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003958 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3959 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3960 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3961 they logout.
3962
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003963 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3964 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3965 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3966 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3967
3968 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3969 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3970 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3971 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3972 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3973 this attribute.
3974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003975 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003977 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3978 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3979 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3980 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3981 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3982 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003983
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003984 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3985 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3986 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3987 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3988 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3989 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3990 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3991 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003992 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003993 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3994 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3995 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3996 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3997 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3998 the site.
3999
4000 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4001 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4002 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4003 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4004 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4005 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4006 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4007 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4008 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4009 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4010 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4011 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4012 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004013 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004014 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4015 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4016
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004017 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4018 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4019 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4020 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4021 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4022 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4023
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004024 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4025 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4026 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4027 repeated.
4028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4030 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4031 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4032 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034 Examples :
4035 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4036 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4037 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004038 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004039
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004040 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004042
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004043declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4044 Declares a capture slot.
4045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4046 no | yes | yes | no
4047 Arguments:
4048 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4049
4050 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4051 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4052 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4053 for use in the response.
4054
4055 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004056 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004057 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4058
4059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004060default-server [param*]
4061 Change default options for a server in a backend
4062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4063 yes | no | yes | yes
4064 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004065 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4066 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4067 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4068 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004070 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004071 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4072
4073 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004074
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076default_backend <backend>
4077 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | yes | yes | no
4080 Arguments :
4081 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4082
4083 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4084 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4085 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4086 will catch all undetermined requests.
4087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004088 Example :
4089
4090 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4091 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4092 default_backend dynamic
4093
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004094 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004096
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004097description <string>
4098 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4100 no | yes | yes | yes
4101 Arguments : string
4102
4103 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4104 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4105 it describes.
4106 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109disabled
4110 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 yes | yes | yes | yes
4113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4116 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4117 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4118 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4119 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4120 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4121 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4122
4123 See also : "enabled"
4124
4125
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004126dispatch <address>:<port>
4127 Set a default server address
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4129 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004130 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004131
4132 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4133 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4134 during start-up.
4135
4136 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4137 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4138 possible with normal servers.
4139
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004140 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004141 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4142 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4143 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4144 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4145
4146 See also : "server"
4147
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004148
4149dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4150 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | no | yes | yes
4153 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4154
4155 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004156 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004157 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4158 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004159 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004160 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162enabled
4163 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4165 yes | yes | yes | yes
4166 Arguments : none
4167
4168 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4169 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4170
4171 See also : "disabled"
4172
4173
4174errorfile <code> <file>
4175 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4177 yes | yes | yes | yes
4178 Arguments :
4179 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004180 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004181 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182
4183 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004184 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004185 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004186 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4187 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188
4189 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4190 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4191 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4192
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004193 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4194
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004195 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4196 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4197 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4198 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4199 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4200 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4201 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4202 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4203 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4206 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4207 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004208 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4210
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004211 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004213 Example :
4214 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004215 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004216 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4217 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4218
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004219
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004220errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4221 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4222 section.
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | yes
4225 Arguments :
4226 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4227
4228 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004229 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004230 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004231
4232 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4233 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4234 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4235 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4236 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004237 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004238 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4239
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004240 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4241 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004242
4243 Example :
4244 errorfiles generic
4245 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4246
4247
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004248errorloc <code> <url>
4249errorloc302 <code> <url>
4250 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 yes | yes | yes | yes
4253 Arguments :
4254 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004255 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004256 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257
4258 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4259 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4260 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4261 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004262 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004263
4264 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4265 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4266 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4267
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004268 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4269
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004270 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4271 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4272 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4273 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004274 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004275 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4276 request.
4277
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004278 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004279
4280
4281errorloc303 <code> <url>
4282 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4284 yes | yes | yes | yes
4285 Arguments :
4286 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004287 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004288 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004289
4290 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4291 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4292 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4293 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004294 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004295
4296 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4297 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4298 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4299
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004300 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004302 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4303 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4304 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4305 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004306 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004307
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004308 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004309
4310
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004311email-alert from <emailaddr>
4312 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004313 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4315 yes | yes | yes | yes
4316
4317 Arguments :
4318
4319 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4320
4321 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4322 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4323
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004324 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004325 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4326 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004327
4328
4329email-alert level <level>
4330 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4331 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | yes
4334
4335 Arguments :
4336
4337 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4338 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4339 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4340
4341 By default level is alert
4342
4343 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4344 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4345 for the proxy.
4346
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004347 Alerts are sent when :
4348
4349 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4350 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4351 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4352 is notice or lower
4353 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4354 and a health check status update occurs
4355
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004356 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4357 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004358 section 3.6 about mailers.
4359
4360
4361email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4362 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | yes | yes | yes
4365
4366 Arguments :
4367
4368 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4369
4370 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4371 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4372
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004373 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4374 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004375
4376
4377email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4378 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4379 mailers.
4380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 yes | yes | yes | yes
4382
4383 Arguments :
4384
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004385 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004386
4387 By default the systems hostname is used.
4388
4389 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4390 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4391 for the proxy.
4392
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004393 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4394 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004395
4396
4397email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004398 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004399 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4400 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 yes | yes | yes | yes
4402
4403 Arguments :
4404
4405 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4406
4407 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4408 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4409
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004410 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004411 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4412
4413
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004414force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4415 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004417 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004418
4419 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4420 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4421 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4422 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4423 marked down for maintenance operations.
4424
4425 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4426 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4427 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4428 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4429 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4430 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4431 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4432 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4433 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4434
4435 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4436 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4437 is used.
4438
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004439 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004440 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004441
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004442
4443filter <name> [param*]
4444 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 no | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments :
4448 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4449 referenced in section 9.
4450
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004451 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004452 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004453 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4454 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004455
4456 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4457 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4458
4459 Example:
4460 listen
4461 bind *:80
4462
4463 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4464 filter compression
4465 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4466
4467 compression algo gzip
4468 compression offload
4469
4470 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4471
4472 See also : section 9.
4473
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475fullconn <conns>
4476 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | no | yes | yes
4479 Arguments :
4480 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4481 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4482
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004483 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004484 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004485 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004486 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4487 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4488 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4489 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4490 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004491 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004493 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4494 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004495 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4496 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4497 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004498
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004499 Example :
4500 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4501 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4502 # connections.
4503 backend dynamic
4504 fullconn 10000
4505 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4506 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4507
4508 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4509
4510
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004511grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004515 Arguments :
4516 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4517 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4518 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4519
4520 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4521 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004522 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004523 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4524
4525 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4526 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4527 simplify it.
4528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004529
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004530hash-balance-factor <factor>
4531 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 yes | no | no | yes
4534 Arguments :
4535 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4536 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004537 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004538
4539 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4540 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4541 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4542 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4543 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4544 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4545 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4546
4547 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4548 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4549 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4550 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4551 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4552
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004553 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4554 consistent hashing mechanism.
4555
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004556 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4557
4558
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004559hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004560 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004564 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4565 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004566
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004567 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4568 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4569 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4570 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4571 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4572 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4573 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4574 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4575 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4576 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004577
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004578 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4579 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4580 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4581 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4582 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4583 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4584 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4585 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4586 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4587 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4588 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4589 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4590 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004591 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4592 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004593
4594 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4595
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004596 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004597 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4598 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4599 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004600 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4601 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4602 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004603
4604 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4605 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004606 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4607 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4608 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4609 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4610
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004611 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4612 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4613 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4614 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4615 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4616 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4617 parameter.
4618
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004619 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4620 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4621 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4622 used on strings.
4623
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004624 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4625
4626 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4627 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4628 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4629 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4630 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4631 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4632 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4633 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4634 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4635 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4636 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4637 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004638
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004639 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4640 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4641 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004642
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004643 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004644
4645
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004646http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4647 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4648 ones).
4649
4650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4651 no | yes | yes | yes
4652
4653 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4654 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4655 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4656 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4657 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4658 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4659
4660 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4661 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4662 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4663
4664 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4665 below.
4666
4667 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4668 instance.
4669
4670 Example:
4671 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4672 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4673 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4674
4675http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4676
4677 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4678 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4679 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4680 example, or to pass some internal information.
4681 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4682 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4683 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4684
4685http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4686
4687 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4688 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4689
4690http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4691
4692 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4693
4694http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4695 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4696
4697 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4698
4699 Example:
4700 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4701
4702 # applied to:
4703 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4704
4705 # outputs:
4706 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4707
4708 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4709
4710http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4711 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4712
4713 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4714
4715 Example:
4716 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4717
4718 # applied to:
4719 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4720
4721 # outputs:
4722 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4723
4724http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725
4726 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4727 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4728 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4729
4730http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4731 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4732
4733 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4734 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4735 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4736 fallback.
4737
4738 Example:
4739 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4740 http-response set-status 431
4741 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4742 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4743
4744http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4745
4746 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4747 inline.
4748
4749 Arguments:
4750 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4751 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4752 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4753 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4754 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4755 (request and response)
4756 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4757 processing
4758 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4759 processing
4760 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4761 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4762 and '_'.
4763
4764 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4765 followed by some converters.
4766
4767 Example:
4768 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4769
4770http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4771
4772 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4773 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4774 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4775 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4776 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004777 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004778 processing.
4779
4780 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4781 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004782 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004783 rules evaluation.
4784
4785http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4786
4787 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4788 details about <var-name>.
4789
4790 Example:
4791 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4792
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004793
4794http-check comment <string>
4795 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4796 it fails.
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | no | yes | yes
4799
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004800 Arguments :
4801 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4802 rule fails.
4803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004804 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4805 user-friendly error reporting.
4806
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004807 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004808 "http-check expect".
4809
4810
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004811http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4812 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004813 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004814 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | no | yes | yes
4817
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004818 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004819 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4820
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004821 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004822 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004823
4824 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4825 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4826 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4827 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4828
4829 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4830
4831 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4832
4833 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4834
4835 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4836
4837 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4838
4839 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4840 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4841 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4842 is used.
4843
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004844 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4845 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4846 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4847 haproxy -vv.
4848
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004849 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4850
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004851 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4852 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4853 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4854 different ports or with different servers.
4855
4856 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4857 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4858 the port with a "http-check connect".
4859
4860 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4861 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4862 do.
4863
4864 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4865 unset-var or comment rules.
4866
4867 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004868 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4869 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4870 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4871 option httpchk
4872
4873 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004874 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004875 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004876 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004877 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004878 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004879
4880 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4881
4882 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004883
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004885http-check disable-on-404
4886 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004889 Arguments : none
4890
4891 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4892 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4893 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4894 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4895 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4896 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4897 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4898 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004899 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4900 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4901 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4902
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004903 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004904
4905
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004906http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004907 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4908 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4909 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004910 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004912 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004913
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004914 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004915 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4916
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004917 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4918 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4919 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4920 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4921 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4922 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4923 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4924 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4925 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4926 result is always conclusive.
4927
4928 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4929 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4930 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004931 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4932 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4933 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4934 example 404 with disable-on-404
4935 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4936 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4937 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004938
4939 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4940 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004941 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4942 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4943 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4944 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4945 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4946 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004947
4948 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4949 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004950 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4951 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4952 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4953 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004954 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4955
4956 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4957 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4958 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4959 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4960
4961 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4962 informational message reported in logs if an error
4963 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4964 log-format string.
4965
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004966 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004967 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4968 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004969 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4970 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4971 details on the supported keywords.
4972
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004973 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4974 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4975 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4976 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004977
4978 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4979 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4980 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4981 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4982 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4983
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004984 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4985 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4986 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4987 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4988 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4989 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4990 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004991
4992 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004993 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004994 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4995 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4996 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4997 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4998
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004999 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5000 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005001 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5002 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5003 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5004 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5005 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5006 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5007 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5008 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005009 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5010 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5011 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5012 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5013 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5014 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5015 insensitive on the header names.
5016
5017 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5018 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5019 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5020 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5021 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5022 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005023
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005024 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005025 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005026 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5027 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5028 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5029 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5030 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005031 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005032 trace).
5033
5034 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005035 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005036 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5037 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5038 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5039 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5040 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005041 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005042
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005043 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5044 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5045 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5046 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5047 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5048 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5049
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005050 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5051 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5052 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5053 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5054 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5055 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5056 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5057 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5058
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005059 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5060 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5061 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5062 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5063 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005064
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005065 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5066 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5067
5068 Examples :
5069 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005070 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005071
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005072 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5073 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5074
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005075 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005076 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005077
5078 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005079 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005080
5081 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005082 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005083
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005084 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005085 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005086
5087
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005088http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005089 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5090 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005091 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5092 health checks.
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005096 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5097
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005098 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5099 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5100 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5101 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5102 to invent non-standard ones.
5103
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005104 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5105 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5106 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5107 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5108
5109 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5110 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5111 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5112 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005113
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005114 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005115 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005116 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005117 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5118 to add it.
5119
5120 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5121 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5122 to the log-format rules.
5123
5124 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5125 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5126 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005127
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005128 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5129 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5130 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5131 request.
5132
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005133 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5134 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5135 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005136 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5137 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5138 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5139 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005140 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005141 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005142 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5143
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005144 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5145 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005146 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5147 so, it will be ignored.
5148
5149 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5150 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5151 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5152 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5153 configured request authority.
5154
5155 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5156 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005157
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005158 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005159
5160
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005161http-check send-state
5162 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
5165 Arguments : none
5166
5167 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5168 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5169 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5170 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5171 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5172
5173 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5174 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5175 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5176 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5177 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005178 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5179 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5180 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5181
5182 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5183 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5184 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5185
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005186 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5187 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5188 checked in multiple backends.
5189
5190 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5191 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5192
5193 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5194 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5195 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5196 one fails.
5197
5198 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5199 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5200 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5201
5202 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5203 server's queue.
5204
5205 Example of a header received by the application server :
5206 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5207 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5208
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005209 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5210 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005211
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005212
5213http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005214 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5216 yes | no | yes | yes
5217
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005218 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005219 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5220 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5221 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5222 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5223 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5224 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5225 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5226 and '-'.
5227
5228 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5229
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005230 Examples :
5231 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005232
5233
5234http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005235 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 yes | no | yes | yes
5238
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005239 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005240 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5241 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5242 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5243 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5244 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5245 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5246 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5247 and '-'.
5248
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005249 Examples :
5250 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005252
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005253http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5254 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5255 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5256 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5257 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 yes | yes | yes | yes
5260 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005261 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005262 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005263 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5264 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005265
5266 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5267 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5268 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5269 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5270
5271 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5272 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5273 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5274 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5275
5276 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5277 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5278 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5279 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5280 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5281 chroot is performed.
5282
5283 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5284 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5285 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5286 considered.
5287
5288 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5289 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5290 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5291 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5292 considered as a raw string.
5293
5294 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5295 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5296 "content-type".
5297
5298 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5299 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5300 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5301 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5302 evaluated as a log-format string.
5303
5304 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5305 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5306 argument to "content-type".
5307
5308 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5309 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5310 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5311 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5312
5313 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5314 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5315 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5316 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5317 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5318 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5319 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5320 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5321
5322 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5323 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5324 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5325
5326 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5327 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5328
5329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005330http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005331 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5332
5333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5334 no | yes | yes | yes
5335
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005336 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5337 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5338 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5339 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5340 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005342 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5343 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005345 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347 Example:
5348 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5349 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5350 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005352 http-request allow if nagios
5353 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5354 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5355 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 Example:
5358 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5359 acl add path /addacl
5360 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005362 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005364 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5365 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 Example:
5368 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5369 acl setmap path /setmap
5370 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005372 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5375 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005377 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5378 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005380http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005382 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5383 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5384 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5385 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5386 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5387 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5388 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5389 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005391http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005393 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5394 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5395 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5396 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5397 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5398 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5399 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5400 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005402http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005404 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5405 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005406
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005408http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005410 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5411 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5412 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5413 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5414 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005415
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005416 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5417 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5418 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5419 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5420 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5421 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5422 instead.
5423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005424 Example:
5425 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5426 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005427
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005428http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005429
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005430 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005435 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5436 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5437 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5438 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5439 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5440 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5441 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5442 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5443 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005445 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5446 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5447 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005448 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5449
5450 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5451 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5452 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5453 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005455http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005457 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5458 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5459 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5460 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5461 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5462 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005464http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005466 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005468http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005470 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5471 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5472 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5473 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5474 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5475 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005476
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005477http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5478http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5479 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5480 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5481 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005483
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005484 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5485 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5486 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005487 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005488 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5489 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5490 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005491 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005492 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005493
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005494http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5495 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5496 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5497 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5498
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005499http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5500
5501 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5502 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5503 pointed by <resolvers>.
5504 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5505 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5506 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5507 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5508 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5509 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5510 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5511 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5512 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5513 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5514 to 0.0.0.0.
5515
5516 Example:
5517 resolvers mydns
5518 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5519 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5520 timeout retry 1s
5521 hold valid 10s
5522 hold nx 3s
5523 hold other 3s
5524 hold obsolete 0s
5525 accepted_payload_size 8192
5526
5527 frontend fe
5528 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5529 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5530 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5531
5532 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5533 # which mean DNS resolution error
5534 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5535
5536 default_backend be
5537
5538 backend b_503
5539 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5540 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5541 # 503 error page to end users
5542
5543 backend be
5544 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5545 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5546 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5547 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5548 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5549
5550 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5551 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5552
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005553http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5554
5555 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5556 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5557 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5558 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005559 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5560 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005561
5562 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005564http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005566 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5567 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5568 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5569 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5570 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005572http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005574 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5575 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5576 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5577 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005579http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005581
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005582 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005583 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5584 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5585 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5586 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5587 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005588
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005589 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5590 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5591 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5592 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5593 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005594
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005595 Example:
5596 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5597
5598 # applied to:
5599 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5600
5601 # outputs:
5602 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5603
5604 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005606 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5607
5608 # applied to:
5609 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005610
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005611 # outputs:
5612 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005613
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005614http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5615 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5616
5617 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5618 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005619 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5620 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5621 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005622
5623 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5624 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5625 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5626
5627 Example:
5628 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5629 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5630
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005631 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5632 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5633 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5634 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5635
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005636http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5637 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5638
5639 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5640 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5641 query-string are replaced.
5642
5643 Example:
5644 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5645 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5646
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005647http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5648 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5649
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005650 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5651 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5652 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5653 against.
5654
5655 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5656 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5657 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005658
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005659 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5660 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5661 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5662 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5663 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5664 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5665 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5666 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5667 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005668 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5669 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005670
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005671 Example:
5672 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5673 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005674
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005675 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5676 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005680
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005681 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5682 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5683 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5684 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005685
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005686 Example:
5687 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005688
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005689 # applied to:
5690 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005691
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005692 # outputs:
5693 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005694
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005695http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5696 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5697 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005698 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005699 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5700
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005701 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005702 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5703 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005704 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005705 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005706 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005707 are followed to create the response :
5708
5709 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5710 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5711 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5712 ignored.
5713
5714 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5715 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005716 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005717 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5718 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005719
5720 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5721 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5722 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005723 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005724 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005725
5726 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5727 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5728 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005729 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005730 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5731 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005732
5733 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5734 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5735 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5736 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5737 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5738 as a raw content.
5739
5740 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5741 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5742 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5743 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5744 considered as a raw string.
5745
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005746 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005747 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5748 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5749 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5750
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005751 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5752 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005753 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005754
5755 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5756
5757 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005758 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005759 if { path /ping }
5760
5761 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5762 if { path /favicon.ico }
5763
5764 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5765 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5766 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5769http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005771 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5772 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5773 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005774
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005775http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5776 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005777
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005778 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5779 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5780 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5781 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005783http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005785 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5786 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5787 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5788 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5789 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 Arguments:
5792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5793 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005795 Example:
5796 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5797 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5800 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005804 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5805 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5806 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 Arguments:
5809 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5810 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005812 Example:
5813 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5814 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005816 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5817 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5818 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5823 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5824 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5825 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5826 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828 Example:
5829 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5830 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5831 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5832 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5833 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5834 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5835 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5836 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5837 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005841 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5842 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5843 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5844 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5845 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5851 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5852 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5853 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5854 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5855 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5856 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5857 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5858 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005860http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5863 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5864 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5865 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5866 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5867 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5868 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5873 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5874 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5879 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5880 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5881 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5882 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5883 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5884 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5885 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005889 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5890 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5891 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5892 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5893 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5894 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005896 Example :
5897 # prepend the host name before the path
5898 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005899
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005900http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5901
5902 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5903 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5904 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5905
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005906http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005908 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5909 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5910 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5911 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5912 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005913
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005914http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005916 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5917 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5918 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5919 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5920 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5921 values have higher priority.
5922 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5923 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5924 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5925 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5926 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5931 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5932 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5933 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5934 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5935 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5936 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005939
5940 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5942 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005943
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005944http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5946 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5947 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005948 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5949 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950
5951 Arguments :
5952 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5953 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005954
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005955 See also "option forwardfor".
5956
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005957 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5959 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5960
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005961 # After the masking this will track connections
5962 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5963 http-request track-sc0 src
5964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5966 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5967
5968http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5969
5970 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5971 expression.
5972
5973 Arguments:
5974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5975 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005976
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005977 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5979 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5980
5981 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5982 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5983 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5984
5985http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5986
5987 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5988 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5989 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5990 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5991 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5992 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5993 information from the request.
5994
5995 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5996
5997http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5998
5999 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6000 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6001 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6002 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6003 path and the query string.
6004 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6005
6006http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6007
6008 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6009 inline.
6010
6011 Arguments:
6012 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6013 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6014 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6015 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6016 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6017 (request and response)
6018 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6019 processing
6020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6021 processing
6022 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6023 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6024 and '_'.
6025
6026 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6027 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006028
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006029 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006035 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6036 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6037 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6038 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6039 agent name must be used.
6040
6041 Arguments:
6042 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6043
6044 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6045 configuration.
6046
6047http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6048
6049 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6050 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6051 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6052 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6053 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6054 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6055 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6056 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6057 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6058 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6059 action.
6060 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6061 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6062 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6063 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6064 you fully understand how it works.
6065
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006066http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6067
6068 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6069 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6070 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6071 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6072 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006073 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006074 processing.
6075
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006076 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006077 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6078 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6079 rules evaluation.
6080
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006081http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6082http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6083 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6084 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6085 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087
6088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6089 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6090 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006091 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6092 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6093 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6094 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6095 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6096 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6097 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6098 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6099 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6100 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006101 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006102 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6103 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6104 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6105 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6106 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107
6108http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6109http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6110http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6111
6112 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6113 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6114 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6115 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006116 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006117 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6118 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6119 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6120 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6121 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6122 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6123 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6124
6125 Arguments :
6126 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6127 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6128 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6129 select which table entry to update the counters.
6130
6131 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6132 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6133 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6134 that table until the session ends.
6135
6136 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6137 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6138 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6139 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6140 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6141 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6142 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6143 useful information.
6144
6145 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6146 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6147 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6148 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6149 checks that make use of it.
6150
6151http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6152
6153 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006154
6155 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006157
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006158http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6159
6160 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6161 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6162 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6163 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6164 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6165 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6166
6167 Arguments :
6168 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6169
6170 Example:
6171 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006175 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6176 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6177 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006178
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006180http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006181 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6182
6183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6184 no | yes | yes | yes
6185
6186 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6187 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6188 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6189 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6190 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6191 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6194 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006196 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198 Example:
6199 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006201 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006203 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6204 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006206 Example:
6207 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006209 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6212 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006214 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6215 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006217http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006219 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6220 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6221 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6222 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6223 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6224 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6225 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6226 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006228http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006230 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6231 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6232 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6233 example, or to pass some internal information.
6234 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6235 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6236 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006237
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006238http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006240 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6241 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006242
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006243http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006244
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006245 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006247http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006249 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6250 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6251 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6252 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6253 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6254 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6255 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006257 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6258 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6259 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6260 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6261 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006262
6263 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6264 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6265 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6266 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006267
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006268http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006269
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006270 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6271 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6272 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6273 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6274 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6275 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006277http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006279 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006281http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006282
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006283 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6284 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6285 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6286 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6287 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6288 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006289
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006290http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6291http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6292 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6293 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6294 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6295 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006296
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006297 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6298 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6299 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006300 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006301 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6302 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6303 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006304 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006305 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006307http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006309 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6310 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6311 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6312 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6313 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6314 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006316http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6317 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006318
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006319 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6320 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006322 Example:
6323 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006325 # applied to:
6326 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006328 # outputs:
6329 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006330
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006331 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006333http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006335
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006336 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006337 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006339 Example:
6340 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006341
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006342 # applied to:
6343 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006344
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006345 # outputs:
6346 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006347
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006348http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6349 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6350 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006351 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006352 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6353
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006354 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006355 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6356 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006357 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006358 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006359 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006360 are followed to create the response :
6361
6362 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6363 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6364 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6365 ignored.
6366
6367 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6368 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006369 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006370 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6371 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006372
6373 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6374 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6375 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006376 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006377 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006378
6379 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6380 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6381 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006382 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006383 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6384 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006385
6386 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6387 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6388 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6389 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6390 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6391 as a raw content.
6392
6393 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6394 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6395 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6396 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6397 considered as a raw string.
6398
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006399 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6400 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6401 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6402 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6403
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006404 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6405 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006406 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006407
6408 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6409
6410 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006411 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006412 if { status eq 404 }
6413
6414 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6415 string "This is the end !" \
6416 if { status eq 500 }
6417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006418http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6419http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006421 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6422 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6423 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006424
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006425http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6426 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006427
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006428 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6429 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6430 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6431 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006432
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006433http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006435 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6436 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6437 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6438 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6439 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 Arguments:
6442 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6445 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006447http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006449 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6450 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6451 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6454
6455 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6456 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6457 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6458 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6459 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6460
6461http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6462
6463 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6464 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6465 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6466 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6467 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6468 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6469 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6470 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6471 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6472
6473http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6474
6475 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6476 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6477 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6478 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6479 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6480 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6481 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6482
6483http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6484
6485 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6486 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6487 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6488 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6489 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6490 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6491 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6492 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6493
6494http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6496
6497 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6498 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6499 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6500 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006501
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006502 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006503 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6504 http-response set-status 431
6505 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6506 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006508http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006509
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006510 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6511 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6512 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6513 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6514 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6515 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6516 based on some information from the request.
6517
6518 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6519
6520http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6521
6522 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6523 inline.
6524
6525 Arguments:
6526 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6527 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6528 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6529 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6530 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6531 (request and response)
6532 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6533 processing
6534 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6535 processing
6536 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6537 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6538 and '_'.
6539
6540 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6541 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006542
6543 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006544 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006545
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006546http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006547
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006548 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6549 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6550 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6551 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6552 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6553 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6554 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6555 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6556 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6557 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6558 action.
6559 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6560 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6561 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6562 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6563 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006564
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006565http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6566
6567 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6568 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6569 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6570 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6571 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006572 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006573 processing.
6574
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006575 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006576 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006577 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006578 rules evaluation.
6579
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006580http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6581http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6582http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006584 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6585 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6586 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6587 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6588 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6589 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6590
6591http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6592
6593 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6594 about <var-name>.
6595
6596 Example:
6597 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6598
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006599
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006600http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6601 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6602
6603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6604 yes | no | yes | yes
6605
6606 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006607 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6608 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6609 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006610
6611 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6612
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006613 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6614 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6615 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6616 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6617 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6618 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6619 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6620 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6621 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6622 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006623
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006624 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6625 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6626 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6627 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6628 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6629 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6630 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006631 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6632 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6633 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6634 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6635 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6636 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006637
6638 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6639 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6640 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6641 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6642 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6643 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6644 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6645 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006646 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006647 downsides of rare connection failures.
6648
6649 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6650 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6651 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6652 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6653 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6654 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006655 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006656 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6657 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6658 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6659 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6660 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6661
6662 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006663 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6664 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6665 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006666
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006667 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6668 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6669 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006670
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006671 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6672 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006673
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006674 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006675
6676 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6677 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6678 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6679
6680 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6681
6682
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006683http-send-name-header [<header>]
6684 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006685 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6686 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006687 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006688 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6689
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006690 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6691 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6692 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6693 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6694 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6695 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6696 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6697 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6698 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6699 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6700 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6701 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6702 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6703 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6704 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6705 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006706
6707 See also : "server"
6708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006709id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006710 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 no | yes | yes | yes
6713 Arguments : none
6714
6715 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6716 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6717 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006718
6719
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006720ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6721 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006723 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006724
6725 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6726 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6727 and running).
6728
6729 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6730 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6731 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006732 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006733 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6734
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006735 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6736 "unless" condition is met.
6737
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006738 Example:
6739 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6740 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6741 ignore-persist if url_static
6742
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006743 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6744
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006745load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6746 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 yes | no | yes | yes
6749
6750 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6751 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6752 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006753 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006754 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6755 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6756 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6757 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006759 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006760 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006761 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006762
6763 Arguments:
6764 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6765 named "server-state-file".
6766
6767 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6768 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6769 name is used as a file name.
6770
6771 none don't load any stat for this backend
6772
6773 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006774 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6775 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6776 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006777 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006778 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006779
6780 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6781 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6782
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006783 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006785 global
6786 stats socket /tmp/socket
6787 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006789 defaults
6790 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006791
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006792 backend bk
6793 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6794 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006795
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006796
6797 Then one can run :
6798
6799 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6800
6801 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6802
6803 1
6804 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6805 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6806 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6807
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006808 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006809
6810 global
6811 stats socket /tmp/socket
6812 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6813
6814 defaults
6815 load-server-state-from-file local
6816
6817 backend bk
6818 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6819 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6820
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006821
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006822 Then one can run :
6823
6824 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6825
6826 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6827
6828 1
6829 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6830 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6831 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6832
6833 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6834 "show servers state"
6835
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006837log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006838log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6839 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006840no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006841 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006844
6845 Prefix :
6846 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6847 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6848 prefix does not allow arguments.
6849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006850 Arguments :
6851 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6852 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6853 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6854 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6855 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6856 parameter.
6857
6858 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6859 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6860
6861 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6862 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6863 standard syslog port).
6864
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006865 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6866 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6867 standard syslog port).
6868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006869 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6870 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6871 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006872 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006873
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006874 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6875 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6876 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6877 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6878 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6879 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6880 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6881 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6882 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6883 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6884 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6885 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6886 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6887 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6888 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6889 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006890 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6891 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006892
6893 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6894 and "fd@2", see above.
6895
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006896 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6897 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6898 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6899 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6900 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6901 having the logs instantly available.
6902
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006903 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6904 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006905
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006906 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6907 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6908 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6909 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6910 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6911 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6912 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6913 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6914 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6915 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006916 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006917
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006918 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6919 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6920 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6921 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6922 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6923
6924 <sample_size>
6925 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6926 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6927 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6928 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6929 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6930
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006931 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6932 one of the following :
6933
6934 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6935 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6936
6937 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6938 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6939
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006940 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6941 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6942 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6943 designed to be used with a local log server.
6944
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006945 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6946 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6947 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6948 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6949 systemd logger consumes.
6950
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006951 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6952 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6953 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6954 used with a local log server.
6955
6956 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6957 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6958 designed to be used with a local log server.
6959
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006960 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6961 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6962 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6963 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006965 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6966
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006967 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6968 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6969 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6970
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006971 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6972 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6973 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6974 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006975
6976 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6977 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6978 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006979 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6980 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6981 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6982 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6983 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006984
6985 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6986
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006987 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6988 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6989 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006990
6991 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6992 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6993 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6994 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6995
6996 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6997 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006998
6999 Example :
7000 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007001 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7002 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7003 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007004 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7005 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007006 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007007
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007008
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007009log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007010 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7012 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007013
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007014 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7015 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7016 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7017 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7018 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007019
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007020 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7021 "option httplog" directives.
7022
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007023log-format-sd <string>
7024 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 yes | yes | yes | no
7027
7028 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7029 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7030 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7031 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7032 which covers the log format string in depth.
7033
7034 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7035 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7036
7037 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7038 log format to "rfc5424".
7039
7040 Example :
7041 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7042
7043
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007044log-tag <string>
7045 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 yes | yes | yes | yes
7048
7049 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7050 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7051 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7052 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7053 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7054 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7055 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7056 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7057 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007058
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007059max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7060 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7062 yes | no | yes | yes
7063
7064 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7065 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7066 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7067 servers.
7068
7069 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7070 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7071 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7072 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7073 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007074 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007075 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7076 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7077 picking a different server.
7078
7079 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7080 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7081 even if they have to be queued.
7082
7083 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7084 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7085
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007086max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7087 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7088 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7089 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007091maxconn <conns>
7092 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7094 yes | yes | yes | no
7095 Arguments :
7096 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7097 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7098 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7099 closes.
7100
7101 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7102 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7103 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7104 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007105 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7106 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7107 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7108 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007109
7110 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7111 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7112 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7113
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007114 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7115 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007116
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007117 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7118
7119
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007120mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007121 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | yes
7124 Arguments :
7125 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7126 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7127 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7128 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7129
7130 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7131 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7132 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7133 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7134 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007136 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7137 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7138 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007139
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007140 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007141 defaults http_instances
7142 mode http
7143
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007144
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007145monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007146 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007149 Arguments :
7150 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7151 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007152 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007153 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7154 backend and its backup.
7155
7156 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7157 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7158 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7159 servers in a list of backends.
7160
7161 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7162 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7163 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7164 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7165 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7166 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7167 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007168 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7169 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007170
7171 Example:
7172 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007173 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007174 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7175 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7176 monitor-uri /site_alive
7177 monitor fail if site_dead
7178
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007179 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007180
7181
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007182monitor-uri <uri>
7183 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7185 yes | yes | yes | no
7186 Arguments :
7187 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7188 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7189
7190 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7191 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7192 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7193 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7194 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7195 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7196 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7197 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7198
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007199 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007200 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7201 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7202 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7203 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7204 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7205 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007206
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007207 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7208 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7209 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7210 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7211
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007212 Example :
7213 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7214 frontend www
7215 mode http
7216 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7217
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007218 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007220
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007221option abortonclose
7222no option abortonclose
7223 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7225 yes | no | yes | yes
7226 Arguments : none
7227
7228 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7229 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7230 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7231 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007232 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007233 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7234 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7235 encountered while delivering the response.
7236
7237 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7238 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7239 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7240 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7241 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7242 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007243 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007244 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007245 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007246 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7247 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7248 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007250 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7251 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007252 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7253 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7254 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7255 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7256 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7257 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007258 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007259
7260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7262
7263 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7264
7265
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007266option accept-invalid-http-request
7267no option accept-invalid-http-request
7268 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 yes | yes | yes | no
7271 Arguments : none
7272
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007273 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007274 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007275 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007276 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7277 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7278 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7279 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7280 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007281 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7282 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7283 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7284 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007285 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007286 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007287 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7288 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7289 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007290
7291 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7292 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7293 been confirmed.
7294
7295 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7296 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007297 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7298 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007299 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7300
7301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7303
7304 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7305 stats socket.
7306
7307
7308option accept-invalid-http-response
7309no option accept-invalid-http-response
7310 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7312 yes | no | yes | yes
7313 Arguments : none
7314
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007315 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007316 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007317 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007318 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7319 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7320 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7321 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7322 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007323 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7324 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7325 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007326
7327 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7328 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7329 been confirmed.
7330
7331 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7332 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7333 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7334 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7335
7336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7338
7339 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7340 stats socket.
7341
7342
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007343option allbackups
7344no option allbackups
7345 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7347 yes | no | yes | yes
7348 Arguments : none
7349
7350 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7351 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7352 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7353 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7354 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7355 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7356 order between the backup servers anymore.
7357
7358 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7359 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7360
7361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7363
7364
7365option checkcache
7366no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007367 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 yes | no | yes | yes
7370 Arguments : none
7371
7372 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7373 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007374 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7376 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007377 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007378
7379 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007380 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007381 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007382 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7383 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007384 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007386 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7387 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007389 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7390 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007391 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007392 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7393 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7394 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7395 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7396 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7397 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7398 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7399 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7400 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7401
7402 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007403 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7404 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7405 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7406 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007407
7408 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7409 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007410 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007411 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007412
7413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7415
7416
7417option clitcpka
7418no option clitcpka
7419 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 yes | yes | yes | no
7422 Arguments : none
7423
7424 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7425 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007426 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007427 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7428
7429 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7430 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7431 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7432 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7433
7434 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7435 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7436 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7437 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7438 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7439
7440 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7441
7442 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7443 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7444 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7445
7446 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7447 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7448
7449 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7450
7451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007452option contstats
7453 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 yes | yes | yes | no
7456 Arguments : none
7457
7458 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7459 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7460 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7461 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007462 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7463 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7464 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7465 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7466 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007467
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007468option disable-h2-upgrade
7469no option disable-h2-upgrade
7470 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7471 connection.
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 yes | yes | yes | no
7474 Arguments : none
7475
7476 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7477 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7478 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7479 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7480 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7481 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7482 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7483 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7484
7485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007487
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007488option dontlog-normal
7489no option dontlog-normal
7490 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7492 yes | yes | yes | no
7493 Arguments : none
7494
7495 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7496 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7497 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7498 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7499 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7500 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7501 logged.
7502
7503 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7504 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7505 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007507 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007508 logging.
7509
7510
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007511option dontlognull
7512no option dontlognull
7513 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | yes | yes | no
7516 Arguments : none
7517
7518 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7519 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7520 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7521 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7522 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7523 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007524 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7525 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7526 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007527
7528 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007530 would not be logged.
7531
7532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7534
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007535 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007536 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007537
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007538
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007539option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007540 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 yes | yes | yes | yes
7543 Arguments :
7544 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7545 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007546 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007547 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007548
7549 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7550 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7551 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7552 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7553 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7554 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7555 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007556 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7557 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7558 possible that the client has already brought one.
7559
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007560 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007561 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007562 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007563 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007564 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007565 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007566
7567 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7568 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7569 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7570 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7571 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7572 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7573 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7574
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007575 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7576 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7577 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7578 are under the control of the end-user.
7579
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007580 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007581 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7582 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007583 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7584 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7585 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007587 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007588 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7589 frontend www
7590 mode http
7591 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7592
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007593 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7594 backend www
7595 mode http
7596 option forwardfor header X-Client
7597
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007598 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007599 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007600
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007601
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007602option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7603no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7604 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | yes | yes | no
7607 Arguments : none
7608
7609 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7610 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7611 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7612 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7613 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7614 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7615 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7616
7617 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7618 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7619 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7620 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7621 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7622 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7623 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7624 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7625 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7626 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7627
7628 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7629
7630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7632
7633 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7634 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7635
7636
7637option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7638no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7639 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7641 yes | no | yes | yes
7642 Arguments : none
7643
7644 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7645 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7646 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7647 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7648 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7649 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7650 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7651
7652 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7653 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7654 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7655 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7656 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7657 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7658 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7659 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7660 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7661 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7662
7663 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7664
7665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7667
7668 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7669 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7670
7671
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007672option http-buffer-request
7673no option http-buffer-request
7674 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 yes | yes | yes | yes
7677 Arguments : none
7678
7679 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7680 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7681 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7682 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7683 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7684 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007685 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7686 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7687 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7688 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007689
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007690 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007691
7692
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007693option http-ignore-probes
7694no option http-ignore-probes
7695 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7697 yes | yes | yes | no
7698 Arguments : none
7699
7700 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7701 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7702 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7703 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7704 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7705 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7706 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7707 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7708 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007709 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7710 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007711 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7712
7713 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7714 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7715 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7716 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7717 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7718 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7719 are often the only way to detect them.
7720
7721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7723
7724 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7725
7726
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007727option http-keep-alive
7728no option http-keep-alive
7729 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 yes | yes | yes | yes
7732 Arguments : none
7733
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007734 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7735 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007736 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7737 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007738 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7739 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7740 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007741
7742 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7743 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007744 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7745 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7746 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7747 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7748 situations where this option may be useful :
7749
7750 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007751 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007752
7753 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7754 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7755
7756 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7757 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7758 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7759 request.
7760
7761 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7762 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007763 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7764 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7765 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007766
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007767 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7768 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7769 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7770 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7771 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7772 not set.
7773
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007774 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7775 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7776 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007777
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007778 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007779 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007780 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007781
7782
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007783option http-no-delay
7784no option http-no-delay
7785 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7787 yes | yes | yes | yes
7788 Arguments : none
7789
7790 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7791 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7792 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7793 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7794 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7795 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7796 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7797 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7798 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7799 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7800 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7801 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7802 affected.
7803
7804 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7805 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7806 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7807 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7808 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7809 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7810 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7811 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7812 latency environments.
7813
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007814 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7815
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007816
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007817option http-pretend-keepalive
7818no option http-pretend-keepalive
7819 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007822 Arguments : none
7823
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007824 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007825 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7826 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7827 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7828 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7829 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7830 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7831 consider the response complete.
7832
7833 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7834 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7835 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7836 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007837 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007838 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7839
7840 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7841 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7842 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7843 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7844 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7845 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7846 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7847
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007848 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7849 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7850 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7851 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7852 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7853 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007854
7855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7857
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007858 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007859 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007860
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007861
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007862option http-server-close
7863no option http-server-close
7864 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7866 yes | yes | yes | yes
7867 Arguments : none
7868
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007869 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7870 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7871 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7872 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007873 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7874 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7875 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7876 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7877 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7878 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7879 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7880 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7881 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7882 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7883 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007884
7885 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7886 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7887 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7888 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007889 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7890 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007891
7892 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7893 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007894 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7895 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7896 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007897
7898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7900
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007901 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7902 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007903
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007904option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007905no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007906 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7908 yes | yes | yes | no
7909 Arguments : none
7910
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007911 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007912 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7913 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7914 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7915 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7916 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7917 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7918
7919 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7920 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007921 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7922 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7923 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007924
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007925 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7926 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7927 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7928 front of an existing proxy.
7929
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007930 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7931
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007932 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007934option httpchk
7935option httpchk <uri>
7936option httpchk <method> <uri>
7937option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007938 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | no | yes | yes
7941 Arguments :
7942 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7943 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7944 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7945 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7946 ones.
7947
7948 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7949 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7950 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7951
7952 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7953 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7954 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007955 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007956
7957 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7958 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7959 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7960 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7961 the lack of any response.
7962
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007963 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7964 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7965 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7966 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7967
7968 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7969 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7970 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007971
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007972 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7973 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007974 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007975 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007976 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007977
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007978 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7979 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7980 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7981 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007984 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7985 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7986 backend https_relay
7987 mode tcp
7988 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7989 http-check send hdr Host www
7990 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007991
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007992 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7993 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7994 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007995
7996
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007997option httpclose
7998no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007999 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments : none
8003
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008004 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8005 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8006 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8007 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008008 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008009
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008010 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8011 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008012 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008013 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8014 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008015
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008016 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8017 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8018 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008019
8020 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8021 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008022 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8023 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8024 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008025
8026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8028
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008029 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008030
8031
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008032option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008033 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008035 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008036 Arguments :
8037 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8038 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8039 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008040 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008041 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008042
8043 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8044 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8045 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8046 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8047 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8048 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8049 ports.
8050
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008051 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8052 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008053
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008054 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008056 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008057
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008058
8059option http_proxy
8060no option http_proxy
8061 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | yes | yes | yes
8064 Arguments : none
8065
8066 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8067 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8068 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8069 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8070 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8071
8072 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8073 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008074 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8075 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008076
8077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8079
8080 Example :
8081 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8082 backend direct_forward
8083 option httpclose
8084 option http_proxy
8085
8086 See also : "option httpclose"
8087
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008088
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008089option independent-streams
8090no option independent-streams
8091 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8093 yes | yes | yes | yes
8094 Arguments : none
8095
8096 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8097 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8098 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8099 receive data or not.
8100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008101 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008102 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8103 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8104 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8105 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8106 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8107 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8108 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8109 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8110 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8111 socket buffers.
8112
8113 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8114 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8115 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8116 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8117 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8118
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008119 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008120
8121
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008122option ldap-check
8123 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 yes | no | yes | yes
8126 Arguments : none
8127
8128 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8129 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8130 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8131 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8132
8133 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8134 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8135
8136 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8137 configure it.
8138
8139 Example :
8140 option ldap-check
8141
8142 See also : "option httpchk"
8143
8144
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008145option external-check
8146 Use external processes for server health checks
8147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8148 yes | no | yes | yes
8149
8150 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8151 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8152 command".
8153
8154 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8155
8156 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8157
8158
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008159option log-health-checks
8160no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008161 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8163 yes | no | yes | yes
8164 Arguments : none
8165
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008166 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8167 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8168 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008169
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008170 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8171 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8172 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8173 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8174 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8175
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008176 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008177 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008178
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008179 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8180 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8181 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008182
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008183
8184option log-separate-errors
8185no option log-separate-errors
8186 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8188 yes | yes | yes | no
8189 Arguments : none
8190
8191 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8192 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8193 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8194 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8195 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8196 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8197 provides very important information.
8198
8199 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8200 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8201 error logs.
8202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008203 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008204 logging.
8205
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008206
8207option logasap
8208no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008209 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 yes | yes | yes | no
8212 Arguments : none
8213
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008214 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8215 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8216 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8217 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8218
8219 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8220 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8221 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8222 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8223 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008224 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008225 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8226 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8227 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8228 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008229 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008230
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008231 Examples :
8232 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8233 mode http
8234 option httplog
8235 option logasap
8236 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8237
8238 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8239 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8240 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8241 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008243 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008244 logging.
8245
8246
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008247option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008248 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8250 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008251 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008252 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8253 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008254 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8255 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008256
8257 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8258 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008260 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8261 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8262 in the MySQL table, like this :
8263
8264 USE mysql;
8265 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8266 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8267
8268 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008269 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008270 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8271 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8272 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8273 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8274 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8275 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8276 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8277
8278 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8279 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008280
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008281 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008282
8283 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8284 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8285 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8286 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008287 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8288 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008289
8290 See also: "option httpchk"
8291
8292
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008293option nolinger
8294no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008295 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008298 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008300 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008301 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8302 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8303 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8304 connections.
8305
8306 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8307 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008308 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8309 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8310 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8311 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8312 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8313 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8314 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8315 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8316 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8317 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8318 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8319 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8320 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008321
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008322 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8323 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8324 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8325 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8326 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008327
8328 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8329 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008330 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8331 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8332 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008333
8334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8336
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008337 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8338 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008340option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8341 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | yes | yes | yes
8344 Arguments :
8345 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8346 matching <network>
8347 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8348 header name.
8349
8350 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8351 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8352 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8353 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8354 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8355 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8356 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8357 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8358 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8359 possible that the client has already brought one.
8360
8361 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8362 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8363 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8364 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8365 header and requires different one.
8366
8367 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8368 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8369 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8370 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8371 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8372 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8373 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8374
8375 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8376 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8377 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8378 both are defined.
8379
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008380 Examples :
8381 # Original Destination address
8382 frontend www
8383 mode http
8384 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8385
8386 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8387 backend www
8388 mode http
8389 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8390
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008391 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008392
8393
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008394option persist
8395no option persist
8396 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008399 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008400
8401 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8402 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8403 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8404 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8405 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8406 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8407 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8408 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8409 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8410 redirected to another valid server.
8411
8412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8414
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008415 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008416
8417
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008418option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8419 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 yes | no | yes | yes
8422 Arguments :
8423 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8424 PostgreSQL server.
8425
8426 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8427 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8428 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8429 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8430
8431 See also: "option httpchk"
8432
8433
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008434option prefer-last-server
8435no option prefer-last-server
8436 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8438 yes | no | yes | yes
8439 Arguments : none
8440
8441 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8442 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8443 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8444 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8445 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8446 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8447 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8448 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8449 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008450 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8451 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008452 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8453 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8454 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008455 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8456 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8457 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008458
8459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8461
8462 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8463
8464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008465option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008466option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008467no option redispatch
8468 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008471 Arguments :
8472 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8473 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8474 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008475 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008476 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008477 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008478 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8479 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8480 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008482
8483 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8484 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8485 be able to access the service anymore.
8486
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008487 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8488 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008489
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008490 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8491 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8492 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8493 following order:
8494
8495 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8496
8497 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8498 list, or
8499
8500 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8501
8502 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8503 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8504
8505 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8506 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8507 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8508 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8509
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008510 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008511 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8512 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8516
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008517 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008518
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008519
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008520option redis-check
8521 Use redis health checks for server testing
8522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8523 yes | no | yes | yes
8524 Arguments : none
8525
8526 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8527 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8528 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8529 find the "+PONG" response message.
8530
8531 Example :
8532 option redis-check
8533
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008534 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008535
8536
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008537option smtpchk
8538option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8539 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008543 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008544 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008545 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8546
8547 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8548 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8549 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8550
8551 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8552 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8553 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8554 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8555 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8556 dead server.
8557
8558 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8559 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008561 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8562
8563 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8564 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8565 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8566 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008567 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008568
8569 Example :
8570 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8571
8572 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008575option socket-stats
8576no option socket-stats
8577
8578 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8580 yes | yes | yes | no
8581
8582 Arguments : none
8583
8584
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008585option splice-auto
8586no option splice-auto
8587 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8589 yes | yes | yes | yes
8590 Arguments : none
8591
8592 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8593 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008594 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008595 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008596 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008597 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8598 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8599 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8600 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8601
8602 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8603 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8604 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8605 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8606 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8607 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8608 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8609 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8610 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8611 keyword.
8612
8613 Example :
8614 option splice-auto
8615
8616 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8617 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8618
8619 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8620 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8621
8622
8623option splice-request
8624no option splice-request
8625 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 yes | yes | yes | yes
8628 Arguments : none
8629
8630 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008631 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008632 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8633 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8634 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8635 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8636
8637 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8638
8639 Example :
8640 option splice-request
8641
8642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8644
8645 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8646 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8647
8648
8649option splice-response
8650no option splice-response
8651 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8653 yes | yes | yes | yes
8654 Arguments : none
8655
8656 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008657 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008658 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8659 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8660 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8661 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8662
8663 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8664
8665 Example :
8666 option splice-response
8667
8668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8670
8671 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8672 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8673
8674
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008675option spop-check
8676 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8678 no | no | no | yes
8679 Arguments : none
8680
8681 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8682 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8683 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8684 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8685
8686 Example :
8687 option spop-check
8688
8689 See also : "option httpchk"
8690
8691
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008692option srvtcpka
8693no option srvtcpka
8694 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8696 yes | no | yes | yes
8697 Arguments : none
8698
8699 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8700 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008701 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008702 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8703
8704 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8705 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8706 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8707 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8708
8709 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8710 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8711 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8712 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8713 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8714
8715 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8716
8717 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8718 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8719 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8720
8721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8723
8724 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8725
8726
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008727option ssl-hello-chk
8728 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 yes | no | yes | yes
8731 Arguments : none
8732
8733 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8734 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8735 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8736 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8737 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8738 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8739 hello message.
8740
8741 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8742 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8743 messages, which is appreciable.
8744
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008745 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8746 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8747 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008748
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008749 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8750
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008751
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008752option tcp-check
8753 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8755 yes | no | yes | yes
8756
8757 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8758 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8759
8760 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8761 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8762 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8763
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008764 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008765 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8766 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8767 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8768 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8769 only.
8770
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008771 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008772 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8773 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8774 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8775 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8776
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008777 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008778 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8779 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008780 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008781 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8782 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8783 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8784 the respective protocols.
8785 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008786 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008787
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008788 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008789
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008790 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8791 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8792 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8793 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008794
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008795 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8796 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8797 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008798
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008799
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008800 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008802 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008803 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008804
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008806 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008807 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008808
8809 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8810 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008811 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008812 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008813 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008814 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008815 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008816 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008817 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8818 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008819 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008820 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8821 tcp-check expect string +OK
8822
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008824 (send many headers before analyzing)
8825 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008826 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008827 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8828 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8829 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8830 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008831 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008832
8833
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008834 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008835
8836
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008837option tcp-smart-accept
8838no option tcp-smart-accept
8839 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8841 yes | yes | yes | no
8842 Arguments : none
8843
8844 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8845 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8846 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8847 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8848 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8849 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8850
8851 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8852 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8853 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8854 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8855
8856 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8857 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8858 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008859 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008860
8861 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8862 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8863 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8864
8865 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8866 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8867 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8868
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008869 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8870
8871
8872option tcp-smart-connect
8873no option tcp-smart-connect
8874 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8876 yes | no | yes | yes
8877 Arguments : none
8878
8879 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8880 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8881 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8882 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8883 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8884
8885 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8886 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8887 complex.
8888
8889 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8890 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8891 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8892
8893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8895
8896 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8897
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008898
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008899option tcpka
8900 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8902 yes | yes | yes | yes
8903 Arguments : none
8904
8905 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8906 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008907 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008908 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8909
8910 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8911 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8912 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8913 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8914
8915 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8916 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8917 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8918 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8919 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8920
8921 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8922
8923 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8924 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8925 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8926 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8927 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8928 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8929 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8930 backends.
8931
8932 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008934
8935option tcplog
8936 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008938 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008939 Arguments : none
8940
8941 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8942 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8943 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8944 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8945 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8946 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8947 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8948 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8949
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008950 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008952 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008953
8954
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008955option transparent
8956no option transparent
8957 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008959 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008960 Arguments : none
8961
8962 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8963 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8964 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8965 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8966 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8967 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8968 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8969 appropriate server.
8970
8971 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8972 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8973
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008974 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008975 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008976
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008977
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008978external-check command <command>
8979 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | no | yes | yes
8982
8983 Arguments :
8984 <command> is the external command to run
8985
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008986 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8987
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008988 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008989
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008990 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8991 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8992 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8993 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8994 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8995 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008996
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008997 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8998
8999 Environment variables :
9000 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9001 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9002
9003 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9004
9005 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9006
9007 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9008 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9009 for a UNIX socket).
9010
9011 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9012
9013 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9014
9015 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9016
9017 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9018
9019 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9020
9021 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9022 socket).
9023
9024 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9025 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9026
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009027 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9028
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009029 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9030 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9031 failed.
9032
9033 Example :
9034 external-check command /bin/true
9035
9036 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9037
9038
9039external-check path <path>
9040 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9042 yes | no | yes | yes
9043
9044 Arguments :
9045 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9046
9047 The default path is "".
9048
9049 Example :
9050 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9051
9052 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9053 "external-check command"
9054
9055
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009056persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009057persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009058 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 yes | no | yes | yes
9061 Arguments :
9062 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009063 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9064 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009065
9066 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9067 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009068 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009069 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9070 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9071 forwarded to this server.
9072
9073 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9074 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9075 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009076 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009077 a single "listen" section.
9078
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009079 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9080 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9081 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9082
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009083 Example :
9084 listen tse-farm
9085 bind :3389
9086 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9087 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9088 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9089 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9090 persist rdp-cookie
9091 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009092 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009093 balance rdp-cookie
9094 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9095 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9096
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009097 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9098 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009099
9100
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009101rate-limit sessions <rate>
9102 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | yes | yes | no
9105 Arguments :
9106 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9107 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9108
9109 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9110 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9111 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9112 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9113 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9114 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9115
9116 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9117 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9118 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9119 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9120
9121 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9122 listen smtp
9123 mode tcp
9124 bind :25
9125 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009126 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009127
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009128 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9129 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9130 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009131
9132 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9133
9134
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009135redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9136redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9137redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009138 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9140 no | yes | yes | yes
9141
9142 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009143 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009144
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009145 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009146 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009147 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9148 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9149 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009150
9151 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9152 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9153 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9154 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9155 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009156 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9157 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9158 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9159 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009160
9161 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9162 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9163 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9164 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9165 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9166 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009167 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009168 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009169 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9170 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9171 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009172
9173 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009174 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9175 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9176 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009177 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009178 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9179 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9180 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9181 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009182
9183 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009184 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009185
9186 - "drop-query"
9187 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9188 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9189 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9190 with a location-type redirect.
9191
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009192 - "append-slash"
9193 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9194 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9195 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9196 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9197
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009198 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9199 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9200 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9201 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9202 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9203 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9204 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9205
9206 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9207 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9208 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9209 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9210 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9211 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9212 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009213
9214 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9215 acl clear dst_port 80
9216 acl secure dst_port 8080
9217 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009218 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009219 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009220 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9221
9222 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009223 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9224 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9225 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009226 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009227
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009228 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9229 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9230 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9231
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009232 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009233 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009234
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009235 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009236 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9237 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9238 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009240 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009241
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009242
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009243retries <value>
9244 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9246 yes | no | yes | yes
9247 Arguments :
9248 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9249 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9250 default value is 3.
9251
9252 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9253 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9254 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9255
9256 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009257 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9258 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009259
9260 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9261 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9262
9263 See also : "option redispatch"
9264
9265
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009266retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009267 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9268 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9269 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | no | yes | yes
9272 Arguments :
9273 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9274 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9275 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9276 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9277
9278 none never retry
9279
9280 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9281 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9282
9283 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9284 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9285 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9286 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9287 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9288 processing the request.
9289
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009290 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9291 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9292 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9293 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9294 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9295 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9296 overflow attack for example).
9297
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009298 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9299 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9300 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9301 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9302 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9303 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9304 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9305 amplify denial of service attacks.
9306
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009307 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9308 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9309 considered to be safe to retry.
9310
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009311 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9312 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9313 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9314 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9315
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009316 all-retryable-errors
9317 retry request for any error that are considered
9318 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9319 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9320 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9321
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009322 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9323 not cumulative.
9324
9325 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9326 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9327 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9328 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9329
9330 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9331 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9332 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9333 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9334 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9335 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9336 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9337 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9338 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9339 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9340 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9341 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9342
9343 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9344 should not use this directive.
9345
9346 The default is "conn-failure".
9347
9348 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9349
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009350server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009351 Declare a server in a backend
9352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9353 no | no | yes | yes
9354 Arguments :
9355 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009356 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009357 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009358
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009359 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9360 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9361 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9362 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009363 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9364 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9365 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9366 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9367 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009368 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9369 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9370 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9371 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9372 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9373 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9374 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009375 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009376 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9377 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9378 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9379 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9380 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9381 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009382 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9383 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009384 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9385 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009387 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009388 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9389 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9390 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9391 adding this value to the client's port.
9392
9393 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9394 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009395 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009396
9397 Examples :
9398 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9399 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009400 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009401 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9402 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9403 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009404
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009405 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9406 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9407 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9408 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9409 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9410
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009411 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9412 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009413
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009414server-state-file-name [<file>]
9415 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9416 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9417 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9418 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9419 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9420 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9421
9422 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9423 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9424
9425 global
9426 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9427
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009428 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009429 load-server-state-from-file
9430
9431 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9432 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009433
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009434server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9435 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9436 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 no | no | yes | yes
9439
9440 Arguments:
9441 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9442
9443 <num | range>
9444 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9445 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9446 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9447 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9448
9449 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9450
9451 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9452
9453 <params*>
9454 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9455 keyword.
9456
9457 Examples:
9458 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9459 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9460 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9461
9462 # or
9463 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9464
9465 # would be equivalent to:
9466 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9467 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9468 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9469
9470
9471
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009472source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009473source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009474source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009475 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9477 yes | no | yes | yes
9478 Arguments :
9479 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9480 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009481
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009482 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009483 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9484 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9485 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9486 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9487 supported prefixes are :
9488 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9489 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9490 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009491 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009492 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9493 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009494
9495 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9496 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009497 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9498 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9499 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009500
9501 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9502 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9503 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9504 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9505 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9506 <addr>.
9507
9508 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9509 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9510 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9511 port.
9512
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009513 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9514 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9515 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9516 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009517 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009518 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9519 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9520 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9521 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9522 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9523 HTTP header.
9524
9525 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9526 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009527 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009528 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9529 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9530 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9531 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9532 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9533 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9534 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9535
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009536 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9537 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9538 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9539 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9540 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9541 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9542
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009543 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9544 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9545 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9546 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9547
9548 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9549 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9550 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9551 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9552 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9553 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9554
9555 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9556 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9557 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9558 there are two methods :
9559
9560 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9561 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9562 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9563 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9564 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9565 of the client ranges may be used.
9566
9567 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9568 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9569 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9570 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9571 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9572 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9573 same session.
9574
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009575 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9576 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9577 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009578 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009579
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009580 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9581
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009582 Examples :
9583 backend private
9584 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9585 source 192.168.1.200
9586
9587 backend transparent_ssl1
9588 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9589 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9590
9591 backend transparent_ssl2
9592 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9593 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9594 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9595
9596 backend transparent_ssl3
9597 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9598 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9599 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9600
9601 backend transparent_smtp
9602 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9603 # with Tproxy version 4.
9604 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9605
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009606 backend transparent_http
9607 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9608 # proxy.
9609 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009611 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009612 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9613
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009614
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009615srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9616 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9617 the connection on the server side.
9618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9619 yes | no | yes | yes
9620 Arguments :
9621 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9622
9623 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9624 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009625 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9626 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009627
9628 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9629
9630
9631srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9632 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9633 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9634 server side.
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 yes | no | yes | yes
9637 Arguments :
9638 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9639 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9640 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9641 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9642
9643 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9644 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009645 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9646 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009647
9648 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9649
9650
9651srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9652 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9654 yes | no | yes | yes
9655 Arguments :
9656 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9657 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9658 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9659 document.
9660
9661 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9662 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009663 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9664 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009665
9666 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9667
9668
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009669stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9670 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009672 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009673
9674 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9675 matched.
9676
9677 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9678 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009680 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9681 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009682 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009683
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009684 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9685 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9686 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9687 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009688
9689 Example :
9690 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9691 backend stats_localhost
9692 stats enable
9693 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9694
9695 Example :
9696 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9697 backend stats_auth
9698 stats enable
9699 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9700 stats admin if TRUE
9701
9702 Example :
9703 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9704 userlist stats-auth
9705 group admin users admin
9706 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9707 group readonly users haproxy
9708 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9709
9710 backend stats_auth
9711 stats enable
9712 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9713 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9714 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9715 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009717 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9718 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9719 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009720
9721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009722stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9723 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009726 Arguments :
9727 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9728
9729 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9730
9731 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9732 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9733 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9734 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9735 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9736 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9737
9738 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9739 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9740 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009741 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009742
9743 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9744 report using "stats scope".
9745
9746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9748 unobvious parameters.
9749
9750 Example :
9751 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9752 backend public_www
9753 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9754 stats enable
9755 stats hide-version
9756 stats scope .
9757 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009759 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9760 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9761
9762 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9763 backend private_monitoring
9764 stats enable
9765 stats uri /admin?stats
9766 stats refresh 5s
9767
9768 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9769
9770
9771stats enable
9772 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009775 Arguments : none
9776
9777 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9778 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9779 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9780 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9781 - stats auth : no authentication
9782 - stats scope : no restriction
9783
9784 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9785 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9786 unobvious parameters.
9787
9788 Example :
9789 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9790 backend public_www
9791 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9792 stats enable
9793 stats hide-version
9794 stats scope .
9795 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009796 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009797 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9798 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9799
9800 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9801 backend private_monitoring
9802 stats enable
9803 stats uri /admin?stats
9804 stats refresh 5s
9805
9806 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9807
9808
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009809stats hide-version
9810 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009812 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009813 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009814
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009815 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9816 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9817 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9818 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9819 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9820 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009822 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9823 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9824 unobvious parameters.
9825
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009826 Example :
9827 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9828 backend public_www
9829 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009830 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009831 stats hide-version
9832 stats scope .
9833 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009834 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009835 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9836 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009837
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9839 backend private_monitoring
9840 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009841 stats uri /admin?stats
9842 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009844 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009845
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009846
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009847stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9849 Access control for statistics
9850
9851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9852 no | no | yes | yes
9853
9854 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9855 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9856 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9857 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9858 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9859 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9860
9861 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9862 instance.
9863
9864 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9865 about ACL usage.
9866
9867
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009868stats realm <realm>
9869 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009872 Arguments :
9873 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9874 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9875 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9876
9877 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9878 using a backslash ('\').
9879
9880 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9881 only related to authentication.
9882
9883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9885 unobvious parameters.
9886
9887 Example :
9888 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9889 backend public_www
9890 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9891 stats enable
9892 stats hide-version
9893 stats scope .
9894 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009895 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009896 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9897 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9898
9899 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9900 backend private_monitoring
9901 stats enable
9902 stats uri /admin?stats
9903 stats refresh 5s
9904
9905 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9906
9907
9908stats refresh <delay>
9909 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009911 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009912 Arguments :
9913 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9914 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9915 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9916 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9917 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9918 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9919
9920 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9921 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9922 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009923 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009924
9925 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9926 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9927 unobvious parameters.
9928
9929 Example :
9930 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9931 backend public_www
9932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9933 stats enable
9934 stats hide-version
9935 stats scope .
9936 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009937 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009938 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9939 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9940
9941 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9942 backend private_monitoring
9943 stats enable
9944 stats uri /admin?stats
9945 stats refresh 5s
9946
9947 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9948
9949
9950stats scope { <name> | "." }
9951 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009954 Arguments :
9955 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9956 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9957 section in which the statement appears.
9958
9959 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9960 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9961 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9962 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9963 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9964 exists.
9965
9966 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9967 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9968 unobvious parameters.
9969
9970 Example :
9971 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9972 backend public_www
9973 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9974 stats enable
9975 stats hide-version
9976 stats scope .
9977 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009978 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009979 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9980 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9981
9982 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9983 backend private_monitoring
9984 stats enable
9985 stats uri /admin?stats
9986 stats refresh 5s
9987
9988 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9989
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009990
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009991stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009992 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009994 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009995
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009996 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009997 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9998
9999 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10000 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10001
10002 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10003 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010005
10006 Example :
10007 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10008 backend private_monitoring
10009 stats enable
10010 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10011 stats uri /admin?stats
10012 stats refresh 5s
10013
10014 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10015 global section.
10016
10017
10018stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010019 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10021 yes | yes | yes | yes
10022 Arguments : none
10023
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010024 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010025 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10026 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10027 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10028 - IP (socket, server)
10029 - cookie (backend, server)
10030
10031 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10032 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010033 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010034
10035 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10036
10037
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010038stats show-modules
10039 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10041 yes | yes | yes | yes
10042 Arguments : none
10043
10044 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10045 values as a tooltip.
10046
10047 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10048 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10049 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10050
10051 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10052
10053
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010054stats show-node [ <name> ]
10055 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058 Arguments:
10059 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10060 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10061
10062 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10063 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010064 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010065
10066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10068 unobvious parameters.
10069
10070 Example:
10071 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10072 backend private_monitoring
10073 stats enable
10074 stats show-node Europe-1
10075 stats uri /admin?stats
10076 stats refresh 5s
10077
10078 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10079 section.
10080
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010081
10082stats uri <prefix>
10083 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010086 Arguments :
10087 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10088 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10089 query string.
10090
10091 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10092 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10093 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10094 possible to reach it in the application.
10095
10096 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010097 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010098 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10099 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10100 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10101 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10102
10103 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10104 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10105 an address or a port to statistics only.
10106
10107 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10108 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10109 unobvious parameters.
10110
10111 Example :
10112 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10113 backend public_www
10114 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10115 stats enable
10116 stats hide-version
10117 stats scope .
10118 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010119 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010120 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10121 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10122
10123 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10124 backend private_monitoring
10125 stats enable
10126 stats uri /admin?stats
10127 stats refresh 5s
10128
10129 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10130
10131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010132stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10133 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010135 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010136
10137 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010138 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010139 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010140 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010141 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10142
10143 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10144 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10145 the "stick-table" statement.
10146
10147 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10148 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10149 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10150 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10151 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10152
10153 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10154 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10155 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10156 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10157 transformation rules.
10158
10159 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10160 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10161 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10162 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10163 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10164 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10165 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10166
10167 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10168 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10169 ACL based conditions.
10170
10171 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10172 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10173 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10174 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10175
10176 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10177 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10178 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10179 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10180
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010181 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10182 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010183 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010184
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010185 Example :
10186 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10187 # last 30 minutes
10188 backend pop
10189 mode tcp
10190 balance roundrobin
10191 stick store-request src
10192 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10193 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10194 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10195
10196 backend smtp
10197 mode tcp
10198 balance roundrobin
10199 stick match src table pop
10200 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10201 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010203 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010204 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010205
10206
10207stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10208 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10210 no | no | yes | yes
10211
10212 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10213 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10214 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10215 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10216
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010217 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10218 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010219 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010220
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010221 Examples :
10222 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010223 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010224
10225 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10226 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10227 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10228
10229
10230 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10231 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10232 backend http
10233 mode http
10234 balance roundrobin
10235 stick on src table https
10236 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10237 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10238 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10239
10240 backend https
10241 mode tcp
10242 balance roundrobin
10243 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10244 stick on src
10245 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10246 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10247
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010248 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010249
10250
10251stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10252 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10254 no | no | yes | yes
10255
10256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010257 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010258 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010259 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010260 server is selected.
10261
10262 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10263 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10264 the "stick-table" statement.
10265
10266 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10267 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10268 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10269 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10270 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10271 address.
10272
10273 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10274 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10275 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10276 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10277 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10278 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10279 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10280 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10281 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10282 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10283
10284 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10285 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10286 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10287 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10288 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10289 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10290 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10291
10292 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10293 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10294 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10295 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10296
10297 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10298 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10299 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10300 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10301 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10302 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010303 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10304 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10305 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10306 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10307 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10308 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010309
10310 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10311 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10312 the request.
10313
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010314 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10315 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010316 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010317
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010318 Example :
10319 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10320 # last 30 minutes
10321 backend pop
10322 mode tcp
10323 balance roundrobin
10324 stick store-request src
10325 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10326 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10327 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10328
10329 backend smtp
10330 mode tcp
10331 balance roundrobin
10332 stick match src table pop
10333 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10334 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10335
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010336 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010337 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010338
10339
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010340stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010341 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10342 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010343 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010345 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010346
10347 Arguments :
10348 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10349 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10350 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10351 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10352
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010353 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10354 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10355 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10356 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10357
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010358 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10359 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10360 instance.
10361
10362 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10363 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10364 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10365 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10366 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10367 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010368 to 32 characters.
10369
10370 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10371 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10372 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010373 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010374 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10375 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010376
10377 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010378 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10379 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010380 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10381 increase.
10382
10383 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010384 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10385 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10386 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010387
10388 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10389 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10390 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10391 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010392 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010393 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10394 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10395 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10396 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10397 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10398 parameter (see below).
10399
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010400 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10401 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10402 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10403 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10404 soft restart.
10405
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010406 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10407 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010408
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010409 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10410 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10411 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10412 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010413 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010414 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010415 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10416 if not expiration delay is specified.
10417
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010418 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10419 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10420 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10421 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010422 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10423 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10424 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10425 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10426 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10427 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10428 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10429 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10430 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10431 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10432 types and their arguments.
10433
10434 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10435 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10436 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10437 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10438
10439 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10440 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10441 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010442 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010443
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010444 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10445 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10446 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010447 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010448 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010449 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010450
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010451 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10452 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10453 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10454 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10455
10456 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10457 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10458 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10459 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10460 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10461 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10462
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010463 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10464 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10465 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10466 they were received.
10467
10468 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10469 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10470 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10471 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10472 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10473
10474 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10477 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10478 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10479
10480 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10481 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10482 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10483
10484 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10485 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10486 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10487 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10488 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10489
10490 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10491 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10492 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10493 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10494 the client side.
10495
10496 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10497 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10498 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10499 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10500 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10501 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10502 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10503
10504 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10505 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10506 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10507 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10508 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10509 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010510 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010511
10512 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10513 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10514 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10515 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10516 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10517 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10518
10519 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010520 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010521 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10522 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10523
10524 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10525 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10526 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10527 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10528 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10529 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10530 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10531 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10532 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10533 recommended for better fairness.
10534
10535 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010536 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010537 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10538 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10539
10540 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10541 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10542 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10543 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10544 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10545 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10546 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10547 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10548 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10549 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010550
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010551 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10552 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010553 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10554 reference it.
10555
10556 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10557 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010558 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10559 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10560 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010561
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010562 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10563 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10564 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10565 something that can be ignored.
10566
10567 Example:
10568 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10569 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10570 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10571 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10572
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010573 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010574 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010575
10576
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010577stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010578 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10580 no | no | yes | yes
10581
10582 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010583 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010584 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010585 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010586 server is selected.
10587
10588 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10589 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10590 the "stick-table" statement.
10591
10592 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10593 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10594 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10595 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10596
10597 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10598 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10599 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10600 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10601 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10602 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010603 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010604 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10605 rules.
10606
10607 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10608 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10609 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10610 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10611 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10612 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10613 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10614
10615 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10616 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10617 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10618 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10619
10620 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10621 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10622 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10623 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10624 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10625 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010626 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10627 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10628 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10629 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10630 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10631 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10632 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10633 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10634 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010635
10636 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10637
10638 Example :
10639 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10640 backend https
10641 mode tcp
10642 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010643 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010644 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010645
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010646 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10647 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10648
10649 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10650 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10651 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10652
10653 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10654 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010655
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010656 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10657 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10658 # at offset 44.
10659
10660 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10661 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10662
10663 # Learn on response if server hello.
10664 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010665
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010666 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10667 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10668
10669 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10670 extraction.
10671
10672
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010673tcp-check comment <string>
10674 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10675 it fails.
10676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10677 yes | no | yes | yes
10678
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010679 Arguments :
10680 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10681 rule fails.
10682
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010683 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10684 user-friendly error reporting.
10685
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010686 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10687 "tcp-check expect".
10688
10689
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010690tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10691 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010692 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010693 Opens a new connection
10694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010695 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010696
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010697 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010698 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10699
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010700 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010701 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010702
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010703 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010704 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10705 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010706 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010707
10708 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010709
10710 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10711
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010712 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10713
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010714 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10715
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010716 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10717
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010718 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10719 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10720 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10721 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10722
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010723 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10724 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10725 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10726 haproxy -vv.
10727
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010728 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010729
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010730 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10731 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10732 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10733
10734 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10735 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10736 of the sequence.
10737
10738 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10739 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10740 do.
10741
10742 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10743 unset-var or comment rules.
10744
10745 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010746 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10747 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10748 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10749 option tcp-check
10750 tcp-check connect
10751 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10752 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10753 tcp-check send \r\n
10754 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10755 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10756 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10757 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10758 tcp-check send \r\n
10759 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10760 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10761
10762 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10763 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010764 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010765 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10766 tcp-check connect port 143
10767 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10768 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10769
10770 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10771
10772
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010773tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010774 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010775 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010776 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010777 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010780
10781 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010782 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10783
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010784 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10785 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10786 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10787 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10788 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10789 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10790 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10791 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10792 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10793 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10794
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010795 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010796 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10797 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010798 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10799 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10800 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10801
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010802 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10803 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10804 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010805 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10806 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10807 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10808 example 404 with disable-on-404
10809 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10810 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010811 By default "L7OK" is used.
10812
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010813 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10814 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010815 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10816 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10817 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10818 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10819 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10820 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010821
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010822 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010823 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010824 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10825 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10826 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10827 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010828 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10829
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010830 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10831 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10832 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10833 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10834
10835 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10836 informational message reported in logs if an error
10837 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10838 log-format string.
10839
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010840 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10841 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10842 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10843 followed by some converters.
10844
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010845 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10846 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10847 with the usual backslash ('\').
10848 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010849 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010850 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10851 used upper or lower case.
10852
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010853 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10854
10855 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10856 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10857 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10858 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10859 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10860 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10861 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10862 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10863
10864 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10865 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10866 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10867 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10868 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10869 expression.
10870
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010871 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10872 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10873 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10874 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10875 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10876 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10877
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010878 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10879 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10880 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10881 this exact hexadecimal string.
10882 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10883
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010884 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10885 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10886 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10887 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10888 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10889 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10890 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10891 size.
10892
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010893 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10894 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10895 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10896 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10897 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10898 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10899 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10900 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10901 in a binary string before matching the response's
10902 buffer.
10903
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010904 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10905 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10906 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10907 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10908 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10909 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10910 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10911 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10912 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10913 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10914 the null character.
10915
10916 Examples :
10917 # perform a POP check
10918 option tcp-check
10919 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10920
10921 # perform an IMAP check
10922 option tcp-check
10923 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10924
10925 # look for the redis master server
10926 option tcp-check
10927 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010928 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010929 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10930 tcp-check expect string role:master
10931 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10932 tcp-check expect string +OK
10933
10934
10935 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10936 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10937
10938
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010939tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10940tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10941 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10942 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010944 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010945
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010946 Arguments :
10947 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10948
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010949 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10950 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010951
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010952 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10953 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010954
10955 Examples :
10956 # look for the redis master server
10957 option tcp-check
10958 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10959 tcp-check expect string role:master
10960
10961 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10962 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10963
10964
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010965tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10966tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10967 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10968 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010970 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010971
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010972 Arguments :
10973 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010974
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010975 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10976 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010977
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010978 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10979 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10980 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010981
10982 Examples :
10983 # redis check in binary
10984 option tcp-check
10985 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10986 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10987
10988
10989 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10990 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10991
10992
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010993tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010994 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010996 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010997
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010998 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010999 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11000 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11001 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11002 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11003 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11005 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11006 and '-'.
11007
11008 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11009
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011010 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011011 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11012
11013
11014tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011015 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011017 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011018
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011019 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011020 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11021 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11024 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11025 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11026 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11027 and '-'.
11028
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011029 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011030 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11031
11032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011033tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11034 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11036 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011037 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011038 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11039 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011041 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011042
11043 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11044 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011045 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11046 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11047 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11048 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11049 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11050 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011052 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11053 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11054 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11055 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011056
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011057 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011058 - accept :
11059 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11060 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11061 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011063 - reject :
11064 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11065 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11066 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11067 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11068 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11069 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11070 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11071 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11072 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11073 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11074 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011075 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011076
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011077 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11078 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11079 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11080 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11081 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11082 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11083 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11084 hosts.
11085
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011086 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11087 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11088 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11089 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11090 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11091 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11092 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11093 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11094
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011095 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11096 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11097 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11098 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11099 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11100 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11101 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11102 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11103 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011104 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11105 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011106
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011107 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011108 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011109 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11110 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11111 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011112 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011113 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011114 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11115 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11116 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11117 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11118 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11119 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11120 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011122 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011123 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011124 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011125 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011126 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11127 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11128 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11131 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11132 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11133 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011135 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11136 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11137 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11138 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11139 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011140 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11141 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11142 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11143 layer7 information is extracted.
11144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011145 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11146 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11147 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11148 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11149 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011150
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011151 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11152 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11153 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11154 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11155
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011156 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11157 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11158 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11159 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11160
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011161 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11162 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11163 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11164 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11165 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011166
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011167 - set-src <expr> :
11168 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11169 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11170 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011171 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011173 Arguments:
11174 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11175 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011176
11177 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011178 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11179
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011180 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11181 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011182
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011183 - set-src-port <expr> :
11184 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11185 expression.
11186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011187 Arguments:
11188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11189 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011190
11191 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011192 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11193
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011194 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11195 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11196 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011197
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011198 - set-dst <expr> :
11199 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11200 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11201 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11202 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11203 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11204
11205 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11206 followed by some converters.
11207
11208 Example:
11209
11210 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11211 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11212
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011213 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11214 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11215
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011216 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11217 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11218 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11219 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11220
11221
11222 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11223 followed by some converters.
11224
11225 Example:
11226
11227 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11228
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011229 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11230 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11231 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11232
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011233 - "silent-drop" :
11234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011236 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11237 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11238 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11239 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11240 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011241 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11242 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011243 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11244 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011245 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011246 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11247 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11248 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11249 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011251 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11252 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11253 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011254
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011255 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11256 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11257 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011259 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011260 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011261 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011263 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11264 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11265 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011267 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011268 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11269 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011270
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011271 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11272
11273 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11274
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011275 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11276
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011277 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011278
11279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011280tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11281 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011283 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011284 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011285 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11286 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011289
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011290 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011291 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11292 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11293 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11294 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011296 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11297 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11298 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11299 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011300 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11301 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11302 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11303 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11304 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11305 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011306 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011307 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011309 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11310 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11311 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11312 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011313
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011314 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011315 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011316 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011317 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11318 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011319 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011320 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011321 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011322 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011323 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011324 - set-dst <expr>
11325 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011326 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011327 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011328 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011329 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011330 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011332 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11333 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011334 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11335 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011336
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011337 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11338 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11339 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11340 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11341 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11342 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011344 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011345 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11346 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011347
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011348 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11349 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11350 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11351 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11352 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11353 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011355 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011356 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11357 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11358 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11359 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11360 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11361 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11362 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11363 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11364 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11365 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011366
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011367 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011368 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11369 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11370 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011371
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011372 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11373 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11374
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011375 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011376 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11377 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011378
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011379 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11380 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011381 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011382 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11383 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011384 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011385 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011386 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011387 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11388 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011389 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011390 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11391 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011392
11393 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11394 followed by some converters.
11395
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011396 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11397 <var-name>.
11398
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011399 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11400 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11401 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11402 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11403 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11404
11405 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11406 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11407 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11408 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11409 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11410 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11411 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11412 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11413 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11414 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11415 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11416
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011417 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11418 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11419 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11420 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11421 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11422
11423 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11424
11425 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11426
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011427 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11428 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11429 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11430 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11431 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11432 evaluated.
11433
11434 Example:
11435 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11436
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011437 Example:
11438
11439 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011440 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011442 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011443 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11444 # and reject everything else.
11445 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11446 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011447 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011448 tcp-request content reject
11449
11450 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011451 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11452 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11453 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011454 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011455
11456 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11457 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11458 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011459 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011460 tcp-request content reject
11461
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011462 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011463 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011464 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011465 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011466 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11467 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011468
11469 Example:
11470 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11471 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011472 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011474 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011475 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011476
11477 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011478 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011479 # protecting all our sites
11480 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011481 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11482 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011483 ...
11484 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11485
11486 backend http_dynamic
11487 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011488 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011489 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011490 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011491 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011492 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011493 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011495 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011496
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011497 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11498 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011499
11500
11501tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11502 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011504 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011505 Arguments :
11506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11508 as explained at the top of this document.
11509
11510 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11511 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11512 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11513 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11514 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11515
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011516 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11517 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11518 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11519 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11520
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011521 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11522 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011523 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011524 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011525 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11526 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11527 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11528 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011529
11530 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11531 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11532 it pass through unaffected.
11533
11534 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11535 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11536 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011537 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11539 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011540 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11541 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11542 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011543
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011544 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011545 "timeout client".
11546
11547
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011548tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11549 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11551 no | no | yes | yes
11552 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011553 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11554 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011555
11556 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011559 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11560 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011561 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11562 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011563
11564 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11565
11566 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11567 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11568 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11569 inserted.
11570
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011571 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011572 - accept :
11573 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11574 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11575 the rules evaluation.
11576
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011577 - close :
11578 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11579 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11580 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11581 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11582 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11583 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011584 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011585 protocols.
11586
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011587 - reject :
11588 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11589 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011590 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011591
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011592 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11593 Sets a variable.
11594
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011595 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11596 Unsets a variable.
11597
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011598 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11599 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11601 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11602
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011603 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11604 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11605 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11606 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11607
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011608 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11609 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11610 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11611 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11612 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011613
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011614 - "silent-drop" :
11615 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011616 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011617 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11618 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11619 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11620 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11621 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011622 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11623 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011624 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11625 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011626 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011627 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11628 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11629 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11630 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11631
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011632 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11633 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11634
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011635 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11636 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11637 for changing the default action to a reject.
11638
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011639 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11640 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11641 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11642 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011643 period.
11644
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011645 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11646 declared inline.
11647
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011648 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11649 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011650 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011651 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11652 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011653 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011654 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011655 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11657 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011659 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11660 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011661
11662 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11663 followed by some converters.
11664
11665 Example:
11666
11667 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11668
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011669 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11670 <var-name>.
11671
11672 Example:
11673
11674 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11675
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011676 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11677 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11678 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11679 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11680 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11681
11682 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11683
11684 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11685
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011686 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11687
11688 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11689
11690
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011691tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11692 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11694 no | yes | yes | no
11695 Arguments :
11696 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11697 below.
11698
11699 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11700
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011701 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011702 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11703 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11704 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11705 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11706 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11707 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11708 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011710 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11711 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11712 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11713 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11714 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11715 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11716 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11717 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11718 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11719 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11720 instead.
11721
11722 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11723 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11724 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11725 rules which may be inserted.
11726
11727 Several types of actions are supported :
11728 - accept : the request is accepted
11729 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11730 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11731 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011732 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011733 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011734 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011735 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011736 - silent-drop
11737
11738 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11739 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11740 sections for a complete description.
11741
11742 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11743 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11744 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11745
11746 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11747 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11748 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11749 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11750 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11751
11752 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11753 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11754
11755 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11756 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11757 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11758
11759 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11760 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11761 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11762
11763 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11764 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11765 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11766
11767 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11768 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11769 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11770
11771 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11772
11773 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11774
11775
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011776tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11777 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11779 no | no | yes | yes
11780 Arguments :
11781 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11782 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11783 as explained at the top of this document.
11784
11785 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11786
11787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011788timeout check <timeout>
11789 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11790 established.
11791
11792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11793 yes | no | yes | yes
11794 Arguments:
11795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11797 as explained at the top of this document.
11798
11799 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11800 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011801 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011802 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011803 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11804 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11805 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011806
11807 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11808 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11809
11810 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11811 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011812 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011813
11814 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11816 forget about it.
11817
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011818 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11819 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011820
11821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011822timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011823 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11825 yes | yes | yes | no
11826 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011827 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11829 as explained at the top of this document.
11830
11831 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11832 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11833 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011834 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11835 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11836 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11837 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011838 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11839 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11840 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011841 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011842 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011843 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11844 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011845 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11846 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011847
11848 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11849 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11850 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11851 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011852 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011853 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11854
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011855 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011856
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011857 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011859
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011860timeout client-fin <timeout>
11861 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11863 yes | yes | yes | no
11864 Arguments :
11865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11867 as explained at the top of this document.
11868
11869 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11870 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11871 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11872 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11873 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11874 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11875 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011876 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11877 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11878 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011879
11880 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11881 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11882 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11883
11884 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11885
11886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011887timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011888 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11890 yes | no | yes | yes
11891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11894 as explained at the top of this document.
11895
11896 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011897 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011898 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011899 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011900 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11901 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011902
11903 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11904 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11905 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11906 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011907 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011908 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11909
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011910 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011912
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011913timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11914 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11916 yes | yes | yes | yes
11917 Arguments :
11918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11920 as explained at the top of this document.
11921
11922 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11923 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11924 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11925 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11926 once the request has started to present itself.
11927
11928 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11929 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11930 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11931 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11932 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11933
11934 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11935 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11936 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11937 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11938
11939 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11940 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011941 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011942 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11943 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011944 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011945
11946 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11947 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11948 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11949 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11950
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011951 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11952 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011953 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11954
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011955 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11956
11957
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011958timeout http-request <timeout>
11959 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011962 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011963 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011964 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11965 as explained at the top of this document.
11966
11967 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11968 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11969 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11970 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11971 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11972 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11973 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011974 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11975 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11976 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11977 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011978 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011979 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11980 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011981
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011982 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11983 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11984 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11985 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11986 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011987 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011988
11989 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11990 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011992 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11993 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11994
11995 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011996 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11997 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11998 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011999
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012000 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012001 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012002
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012003
12004timeout queue <timeout>
12005 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12007 yes | no | yes | yes
12008 Arguments :
12009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12011 as explained at the top of this document.
12012
12013 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12014 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12015 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12016 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12017 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12018
12019 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12020 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12021 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12022 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12023
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012024 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012025
12026
12027timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012028 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12030 yes | no | yes | yes
12031 Arguments :
12032 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12033 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12034 as explained at the top of this document.
12035
12036 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12037 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12038 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12039 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12040 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12041 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12042 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12043
12044 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12045 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12046 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12047 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12048 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012049 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012050 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012051 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12052 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012053 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12054 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012055
12056 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12057 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12058 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12059 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012060 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012061 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12062
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012063 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012064
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012065
12066timeout server-fin <timeout>
12067 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12069 yes | no | yes | yes
12070 Arguments :
12071 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12072 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12073 as explained at the top of this document.
12074
12075 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12076 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12077 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12078 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12079 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12080 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12081 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12082 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12083 situations, it should not be needed.
12084
12085 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12086 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12087 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12088
12089 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12090
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012091
12092timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012093 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12095 yes | yes | yes | yes
12096 Arguments :
12097 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12099 as explained at the top of this document.
12100
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012101 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12102 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12103 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012104
12105 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12106 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12107 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12108 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012109 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012110
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012111 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012112
12113
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012114timeout tunnel <timeout>
12115 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12117 yes | no | yes | yes
12118 Arguments :
12119 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12120 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12121 as explained at the top of this document.
12122
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012123 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012124 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12125 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12126 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12128 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012129 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12130 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12131 specified.
12132
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012133 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12134 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12135 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12136 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12137 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12138 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12139 state.
12140
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012141 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12142 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12143 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12144 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012145 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012146
12147 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12148 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12149 forget about it.
12150
12151 Example :
12152 defaults http
12153 option http-server-close
12154 timeout connect 5s
12155 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012156 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012157 timeout server 30s
12158 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12159
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012160 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012161
12162
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012163transparent (deprecated)
12164 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012166 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012167 Arguments : none
12168
12169 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12170 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12171 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12172 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12173 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12174 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12175 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12176 appropriate server.
12177
12178 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12179
12180 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12181 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12182
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012183 See also: "option transparent"
12184
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012185unique-id-format <string>
12186 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12188 yes | yes | yes | no
12189 Arguments :
12190 <string> is a log-format string.
12191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012192 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12193 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12194 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12195 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012197 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12198 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12199 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12200 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12201 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12202 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12203 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12204 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012205
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012206 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12207 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012209 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012210
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012211 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012212
12213 will generate:
12214
12215 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12216
12217 See also: "unique-id-header"
12218
12219unique-id-header <name>
12220 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12222 yes | yes | yes | no
12223 Arguments :
12224 <name> is the name of the header.
12225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012226 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12227 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012228
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012229 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012230
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012231 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012232 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12233
12234 will generate:
12235
12236 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12237
12238 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012239
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012240use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012241 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12243 no | yes | yes | no
12244 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012245 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12246 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012247
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012248 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12249 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012250
12251 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12252 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12253 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012254 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012255 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012256 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12257 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012258
12259 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12260 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12261 assign the backend.
12262
12263 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12264 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12265 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12266 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12267 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12268 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12269
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012270 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012271 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012272 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12273 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12274 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12275
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012276 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12277 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12278 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12279 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12280 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12281 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12282 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12283 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12284 cannot be forced from the request.
12285
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012286 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012287 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12288 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12289
12290 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12291 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012292
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012293use-fcgi-app <name>
12294 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12296 no | no | yes | yes
12297 Arguments :
12298 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12299
12300 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012301
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012302use-server <server> if <condition>
12303use-server <server> unless <condition>
12304 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12306 no | no | yes | yes
12307 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012308 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12309 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012310
12311 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12312
12313 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12314 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12315 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12316
12317 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12318 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12319 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12320 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12321 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12322 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12323 matches will assign the server.
12324
12325 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12326 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12327 with the next rules until one matches.
12328
12329 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12330 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12331 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12332 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12333
12334 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12335 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12336 stripped.
12337
12338 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12339 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012340 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12341 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12342 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012343
12344 Example :
12345 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12346 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12347 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12348 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012349 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012350 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012351 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012352 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12353 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12354
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012355 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12356 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12357 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12358 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012359 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012360 and we fall back to load balancing.
12361
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012362 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012366--------------------------
12367
12368The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12369depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12370settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12371written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12372described in this section.
12373
12374
123755.1. Bind options
12376-----------------
12377
12378The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12379as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12380no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12381parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12382while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12383provided immediately after the setting name.
12384
12385The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12386
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012387accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12388 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12389 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12390 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12391 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12392 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12393 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12394 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12395 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12396 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012397 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12398 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12399 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012400
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012401accept-proxy
12402 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012403 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12404 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012405 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12406 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12407 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12408 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012409 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012410 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12411 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012412 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12413 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012414
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012415allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012416 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012417 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012418 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012419 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12420 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012421
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012422alpn <protocols>
12423 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12424 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12425 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012426 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012427 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012428 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12429 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12430 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12431 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12432 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12433 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12434 preference, like below :
12435
12436 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012438backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012439 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012440 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12441
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012442curves <curves>
12443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12444 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12445 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12446 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12447 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12448 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12449
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012450ecdhe <named curve>
12451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012452 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12453 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012454
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012455ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12457 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12458 client's certificate.
12459
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012460ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12462 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12463 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12464 error is ignored.
12465
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012466ca-sign-file <cafile>
12467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12468 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12469 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12470 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12471 'generate-certificates' for details.
12472
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012473ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12475 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12476 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12477 'generate-certificates' for details.
12478
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012479ca-verify-file <cafile>
12480 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12481 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12482 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12483 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12484 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012486ciphers <ciphers>
12487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12488 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012489 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012490 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012491 information and recommendations see e.g.
12492 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12493 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12494 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12495
12496ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12498 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12499 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12500 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012501 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12502 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012503
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012504crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12506 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12507 to verify client's certificate.
12508
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012509crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012510 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12511 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12512 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12513 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12514 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012515 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12516 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012517
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012518 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12519 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12520
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012521 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12522 are loaded.
12523
12524 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012525 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12526 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12527 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12528 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12529 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12530 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12531 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012532 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012533
12534 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12535 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12536 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12537 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012538 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12539 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012540
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012541 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012543 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012544 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012545 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12546 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012547 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12548 clients).
12549
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012550 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12551 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12552 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12553 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12554 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12555 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12556 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12557 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12558 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12559 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12560 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12561 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12562 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12563
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012564 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12565 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12566 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12567 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12568 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12569
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012570 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12571 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12572 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12573 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012574
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012575 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12576 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12577 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012578
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012579crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012581 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012582 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012583 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012584
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012585crt-list <file>
12586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012587 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12588 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012589
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012590 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12591
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012592 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12593 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12594 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12595 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12596 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012597
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012598 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012599 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12600 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12601 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12602 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12603 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012604 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12605 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12606 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012607
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012608 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12609 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12610 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012611
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012612 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12613
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012614 The first valid line declares the default certificate, which haproxy should
12615 use in the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches, just like the crt
12616 bind option. This certificate will also be used if the provided SNI matches
12617 its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI filter is declared later. The SNI filter
12618 !* can be used after the first certificate to not include its CN and SAN in
12619 the SNI tree, so it will never match except if no other certificate matches.
12620 This way the first declared certificate act as a fallback.
12621
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012622 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012623 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012624 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012625 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012626 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012627 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012629defer-accept
12630 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12631 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12632 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012633 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012634 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12635 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12636 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12637 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12638 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12639 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12640 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12641
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012642expose-fd listeners
12643 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12644 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012645 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12646 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012648
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012649force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012650 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012651 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012652 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012653 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012654
12655force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012656 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012657 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012658 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012659
12660force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012661 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012662 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012663 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012664
12665force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012666 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012667 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012668 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012669
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012670force-tlsv13
12671 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12672 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012673 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012674
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012675generate-certificates
12676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12677 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12678 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12679 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12680 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12681 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12682 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12683 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12684 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12685 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12686 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12687
12688 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12689 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012690 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012691 certificate is used many times.
12692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012693gid <gid>
12694 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12695 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12696 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12697 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12698 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12699
12700group <group>
12701 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12702 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12703 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12704 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12705 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12706
12707id <id>
12708 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12709 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12710 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12711 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12712
12713interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012714 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12715 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12716 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12717 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12718 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12719 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012720 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12721 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12722 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12723 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12724 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12725 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012726
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012727level <level>
12728 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12729 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12730 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012731 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012732 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12733 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12734 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012735 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012736 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012737 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012738 all counters).
12739
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012740severity-output <format>
12741 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12742 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12743 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12744 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12745 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12746 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12747 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12748 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12749 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12750 rfc5424 convention.
12751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012752maxconn <maxconn>
12753 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12754 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12755 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12756 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12757 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12758 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12759 eat all memory.
12760
12761mode <mode>
12762 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12763 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12764 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12765 UNIX sockets.
12766
12767mss <maxseg>
12768 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12769 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12770 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12771 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12772 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12773 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12774 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12775 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12776 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12777 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12778 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12779
12780name <name>
12781 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12782 page.
12783
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012784namespace <name>
12785 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12786 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12787 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12788 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012790nice <nice>
12791 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12792 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12793 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12794 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12795 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12796 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12797 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12798 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12799 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12800 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12801 one for an RDP socket.
12802
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012803no-ca-names
12804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12805 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012806 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012807
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012808no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012810 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012811 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012812 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012813 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12814 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012815
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012816no-tls-tickets
12817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12818 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12819 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012820 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12821 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012822 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12823 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12824 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012825
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012826no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012828 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012829 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012830 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012831 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12832 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012833
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012834no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012836 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012837 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012838 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012839 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12840 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012842no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012844 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012845 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012846 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012847 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12848 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012849
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012850no-tlsv13
12851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12852 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12853 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12854 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012855 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12856 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012857
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012858npn <protocols>
12859 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12860 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12861 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012862 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012863 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012864 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12865 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12866 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12867 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12868 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012869
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012870prefer-client-ciphers
12871 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12872 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12873 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012874 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12875 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12876 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012877
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012878process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012879 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012880 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012881 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012882 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12883 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12884 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12885 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012886 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012887 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12888 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12889 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12890 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12891 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012892
12893 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12894
12895 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12896 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12897 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12898 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12899 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12900 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12901 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12902 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012903
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012904proto <name>
12905 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12906 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12907 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12908 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012909 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012910 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012911 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012912 h2" on the bind line.
12913
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012914ssl
12915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012916 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012917 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12918 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012919 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12920 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012921
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012922ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12923 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012924 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12925 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12926 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012927 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12928
12929ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012930 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12931 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12932 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12933 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012934
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012935strict-sni
12936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12937 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12938 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12939 See the "crt" option for more information.
12940
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012941tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012942 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012943 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12944 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012945 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012946 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12947 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12948 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12949 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12950 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12951 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12952 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12953
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012954tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012955 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012956 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12957 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12958 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12959 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12960 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12961 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12962 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012963 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12964 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12965 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012966
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012967tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12968 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012969 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12970 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12971 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12972 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12973 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12974 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12975 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12976 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12977 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12978 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012979 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12980 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12981
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012982transparent
12983 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12984 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12985 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12986 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12987 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12988 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12989 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12990 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12991 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12992 so check for support with your vendor.
12993
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012994v4v6
12995 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12996 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12997 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12998 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012999 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013000
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013001v6only
13002 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13003 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13004 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013005 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13006 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013008uid <uid>
13009 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13010 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13011 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13012 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13013 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13014
13015user <user>
13016 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13017 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13018 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13019 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13020 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13021
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013022verify [none|optional|required]
13023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13024 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13025 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13026 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13027 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013028 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13029 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13030 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13031 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130335.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013034------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013036The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13037which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13038arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13039settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13040after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13041Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13042address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013044 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013045 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013046
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013047Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13048keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013050The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013051
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013052addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013053 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013054 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13055 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13056 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13057 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13058 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013059
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013060agent-check
13061 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013062 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013063 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13064 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13065 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013066
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013067 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013068 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013069 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13070 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13071 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013073 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13074 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13075 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13076 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13077 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013078
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013079 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013080 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013081
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013082 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13083 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13084 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013086 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13087 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13088 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013089
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013090 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013091 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13092 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13093 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13094 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013095 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013096 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013098 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13099 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013100
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013101 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13102 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13103 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13104 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13105 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13106 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13107 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13108 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13109 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013110
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013111 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13112 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013113 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13114 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13115 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013116 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013117
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013118 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013119 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013120
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013121agent-send <string>
13122 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13123 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13124 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13125 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13126 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13127
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013128agent-inter <delay>
13129 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13130 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13131
13132 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13133 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13134 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13135 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13136 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13137 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13138 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13139 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13140 of backends use the same servers.
13141
13142 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13143
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013144agent-addr <addr>
13145 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13146
13147 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13148 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13149 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13150 hostname, it will be resolved.
13151
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013152agent-port <port>
13153 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13154
13155 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13156
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013157allow-0rtt
13158 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013159 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13160 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013161
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013162alpn <protocols>
13163 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13164 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13165 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013166 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013167 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13168 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13169 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13170 now obsolete NPN extension.
13171 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13172 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13173
13174 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013176backup
13177 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13178 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13179 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13180 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013181 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13182 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013183
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013184ca-file <cafile>
13185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13186 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13187 server's certificate.
13188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013190 This option enables health checks on a server:
13191 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13192 considered available.
13193 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13194 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13195 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13196 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13197 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13198 set.
13199 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13200 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13201 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13202 exchanges succeed.
13203
13204 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13205 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13206 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13207 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13208 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013209 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013210 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13211
13212 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13213 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13214
13215 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13216 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13217
13218 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13219 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13220 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13221 available.
13222
13223 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13224 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13225 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13226
13227 Example:
13228 # simple tcp check
13229 backend foo
13230 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13231 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13232 backend foo
13233 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13234 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13235 backend foo
13236 option tcp-check
13237 tcp-check connect
13238 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013239
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013240check-send-proxy
13241 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13242 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13243 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13244 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13245 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13246 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13247 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13248
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013249check-alpn <protocols>
13250 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13251 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13252 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13253
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013254check-proto <name>
13255 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13256 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13257 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13258 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013259 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013260 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13261 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13262
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013263check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013264 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013265 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13266 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013267
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013268check-ssl
13269 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13270 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13271 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13272 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013273 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013274 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13275 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013276 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013277 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13278 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013279
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013280check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013281 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013282 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13283 for normal traffic.
13284
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013285ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13287 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13288 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013289 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13290 information and recommendations see e.g.
13291 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13292 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13293 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013294
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013295ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13297 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13298 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13299 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013300 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13301 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13302 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304cookie <value>
13305 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13306 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13307 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13308 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13309 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13310 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13311 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13312
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013313crl-file <crlfile>
13314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13315 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13316 to verify server's certificate.
13317
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013318crt <cert>
13319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13320 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13321 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13322 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13323 certificate request.
13324
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013325disabled
13326 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13327 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13328 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13329 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13330 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013331 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013332
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013333enabled
13334 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13335 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13336 default value.
13337 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13338 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013340error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013341 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13342 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13343 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013345 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013347fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013348 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13349 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13350 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13351
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013352force-sslv3
13353 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13354 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013355 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013356 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013357
13358force-tlsv10
13359 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013360 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013361 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013362
13363force-tlsv11
13364 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013365 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013366 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013367
13368force-tlsv12
13369 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013370 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013371 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013372
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013373force-tlsv13
13374 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13375 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013376 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013378id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013379 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13380 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13381 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013382
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013383init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13384 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13385 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013386 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013387 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13388 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13389 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13390 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13391 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13392 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13393 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13394 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13395 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013396 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013397 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13398 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13399 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13400 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13401 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13402 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013404
13405 Example:
13406 defaults
13407 # never fail on address resolution
13408 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013410inter <delay>
13411fastinter <delay>
13412downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013413 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13414 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13415 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13416 between checks depending on the server state :
13417
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013418 Server state | Interval used
13419 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13420 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13421 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13422 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13423 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13424 or yet unchecked. |
13425 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13426 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13427 | "inter" otherwise.
13428 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013430 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13431 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13432 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13433 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013434 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13435 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13436 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13437 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13438 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013440log-proto <logproto>
13441 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13442 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13443 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13444 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013446maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013447 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13448 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013449 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13450 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013451 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13452 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13453 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13454 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13455
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013456 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13457 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13458 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13459 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13460 than 50 concurrent requests.
13461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013462maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013463 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13464 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13465 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13466 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013467 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13468 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13469 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13470 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13471 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13472 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13473 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013474
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013475max-reuse <count>
13476 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13477 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13478 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13479 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13480 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13481 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13482 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13483 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013485minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013486 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13487 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13488 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13489 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13490 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13491 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013492 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013493 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013494
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013495namespace <name>
13496 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13497 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13498 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13499 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13500
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013501no-agent-check
13502 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13503 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13504 default value.
13505 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13506 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13507
13508no-backup
13509 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13510 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13511 default value.
13512 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13513 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13514
13515no-check
13516 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13517 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13518 default value.
13519 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13520 "default-server" "check" setting.
13521
13522no-check-ssl
13523 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13524 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13525 default value.
13526 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13527 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13528
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013529no-send-proxy
13530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13532 default value.
13533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13534 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13535
13536no-send-proxy-v2
13537 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13538 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13539 default value.
13540 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13541 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13542
13543no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13544 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13545 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13546 default value.
13547 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13548 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13549
13550no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13551 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13552 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13553 default value.
13554 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13555 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13556
13557no-ssl
13558 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13559 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13560 default value.
13561 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13562 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13563
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013564 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13565 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13566 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13567
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013568no-ssl-reuse
13569 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13570 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13571 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13572 and for paranoid users.
13573
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013574no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013575 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13576 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013577 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013578
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013579 Supported in default-server: No
13580
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013581no-tls-tickets
13582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13583 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13584 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013585 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13586 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013587 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13588 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13589 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013590 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013591
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013592no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013593 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013594 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13595 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013596 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13597 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013598 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013599
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013600 Supported in default-server: No
13601
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013602no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013603 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013604 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13605 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013606 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13607 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013608 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013609
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013610 Supported in default-server: No
13611
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013612no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013613 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013614 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13615 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013616 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13617 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013618 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013619
13620 Supported in default-server: No
13621
13622no-tlsv13
13623 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13624 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13625 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13626 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13627 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013628 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013629
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013630 Supported in default-server: No
13631
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013632no-verifyhost
13633 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13634 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13635 default value.
13636 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13637 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013638
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013639no-tfo
13640 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13641 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13642 default value.
13643 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13644 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13645
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013646non-stick
13647 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13648 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13649 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13650
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013651npn <protocols>
13652 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13653 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13654 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013655 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013656 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13657 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13658 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013660observe <mode>
13661 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13662 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13663 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13664 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13665 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13666 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013667 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013668
13669 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013671on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013672 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13673 Currently, four modes are available:
13674 - fastinter: force fastinter
13675 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13676 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13677 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13678 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13679
13680 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13681
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013682on-marked-down <action>
13683 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13684 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013685 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13686 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13687 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13688 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13689 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13690 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13691 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13692 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013693
13694 Actions are disabled by default
13695
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013696on-marked-up <action>
13697 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13698 Currently one action is available:
13699 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13700 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13701 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13702 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13704 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013705 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13706 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13707
13708 Actions are disabled by default
13709
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013710pool-low-conn <max>
13711 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13712 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13713 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13714 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13715 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13716 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13717 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13718 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13719 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13720 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13721 applying to "http-reuse".
13722
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013723pool-max-conn <max>
13724 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13725 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13726 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13727 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13728 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13729 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13730
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013731pool-purge-delay <delay>
13732 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013733 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013734 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013736port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013737 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13738 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13739 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13740 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13741 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13742 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13743
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013744proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013745 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13746 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13747 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13748 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013749 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013750 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013752redir <prefix>
13753 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13754 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13755 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13756 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13757 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13758 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13759 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13760 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013761 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013762 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013763 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13764 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13765 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13766 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13767
13768 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013770rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013771 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13772 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13773 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13774
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013775resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13776 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13777 server.
13778
13779 Available options:
13780
13781 * allow-dup-ip
13782 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13783 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13784 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13785 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13786 For such case, simply enable this option.
13787 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13788
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013789 * ignore-weight
13790 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13791 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13792 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13793
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013794 * prevent-dup-ip
13795 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13796 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13797 same fqdn.
13798 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13799
13800 Example:
13801 backend b_myapp
13802 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13803 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13804 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13805
13806 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13807 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13808 it
13809 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13810 different address
13811
13812 Default value: not set
13813
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013814resolve-prefer <family>
13815 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13816 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13817 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13818 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13819
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013820 Default value: ipv6
13821
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013822 Example:
13823
13824 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013825
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013826resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013827 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013828 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013829 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13831 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013832 configured network, another address is selected.
13833
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013834 Example:
13835
13836 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013837
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013838resolvers <id>
13839 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13840 hostname.
13841
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013842 Example:
13843
13844 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013846 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013847
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013848send-proxy
13849 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13850 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13851 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13852 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013853 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13854 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13855 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13856 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13857 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13858 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13859 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13860 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13861 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13862 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013863 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13864 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013865
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013866send-proxy-v2
13867 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13868 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13869 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13870 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013871 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13872 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13873 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13874 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013875
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013876proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013877 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13878 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13879
13880 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13881 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13882 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13883 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13884 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13885 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13886 connection is supported).
13887 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13888 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13889 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13890 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13891 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13892 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13893 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013894
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013895send-proxy-v2-ssl
13896 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13897 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13898 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13899 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13900 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13901 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13902 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013903 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13904 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013905
13906send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13907 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13908 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13909 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13910 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13911 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13912 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13913 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13914 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13916 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013918slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013919 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13920 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13921 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13922 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13923 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13924 parameters :
13925
13926 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13927 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13928
13929 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13930 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13931 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13932 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13933
13934 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13935 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13936 seen as failed.
13937
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013938sni <expression>
13939 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13940 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13941 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13942 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013943 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13944 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013945 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013946 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13947 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013948
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013949source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013950source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013951source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013952 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13953 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13954 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13955 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13956
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013957 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13958 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13959 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13960 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13961 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13962 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13963 server.
13964
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013965 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13966 specifying the source address without port(s).
13967
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013968ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013969 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13970 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13971 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13972 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13973 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13974 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013975 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13976 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013977
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013978ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13979 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13980 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13981 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13982
13983ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13984 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13985 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13986 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13987
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013988ssl-reuse
13989 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13990 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13991 default value.
13992 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13993 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13994
13995stick
13996 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13997 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13998 default value.
13999 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14000 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014001
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014002socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014003 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014004 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14005 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14006
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014007tcp-ut <delay>
14008 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14009 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14010 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014012 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14013 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14014 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14015 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14016 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14017 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14018 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14019 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14020 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14021
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014022tfo
14023 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14024 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14025 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14026 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14027 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014028 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014030track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014031 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14032 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14033 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14034 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014035 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14036
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014037tls-tickets
14038 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14039 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14040 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014041 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14042 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14043 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014044 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014045 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014046
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014047verify [none|required]
14048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014049 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014050 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14051 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014052 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014053 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14054 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14055 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14056 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14057 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14058 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14059 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14060 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014061
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014062verifyhost <hostname>
14063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014064 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14065 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14066 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14067 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14068 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14069 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14070 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14071 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014072
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014073weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014074 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14075 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14076 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014077 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14078 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14079 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14080 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14081 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14082 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014083
14084
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140855.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14086-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014087
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014088HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14089using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14090configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014091This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14092can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14093workload.
14094This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14095resolution at run time.
14096Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14097carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14098
14099
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141005.3.1. Global overview
14101----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014102
14103As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14104different steps of the process life:
14105
14106 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14107 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14108 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14109
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014110 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14111 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014112
14113A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14114 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14115 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14116 resolution to know this new IP.
14117
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014118When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014120SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14121from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14122will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14123will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014124
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014125A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014126 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014127 first valid response.
14128
14129 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14130 servers return an error.
14131
14132
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141335.3.2. The resolvers section
14134----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014135
14136This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014137HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14138contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014139
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014140When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14141uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14142is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14143answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14144
14145When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014146used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014147
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014148 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14149 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14150 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014151
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014152 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14153 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014154
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014155 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14156 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14157 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014158
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014159For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14160following scenarios are possible:
14161
14162 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14163 ignored
14164
14165 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14166 applied
14167
14168 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14169 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14170
14171 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14172 retries the query with a new type
14173
14174 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14175 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014176
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014177As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14178a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014179<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014180
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014181
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014182resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014183 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184
14185A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14186
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014187accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014188 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014189 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014190 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14191 by RFC 6891)
14192
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014193 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14194
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14196 DNS server description:
14197 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14198 <ip> : IP address of the server
14199 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14200
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014201parse-resolv-conf
14202 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14203 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14204 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14205
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014206hold <status> <period>
14207 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14208 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014209 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014210 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014211 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14212 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14213 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14214
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014215 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014216
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014217resolve_retries <nb>
14218 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14219 giving up.
14220 Default value: 3
14221
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014222 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14223 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14224 type.
14225
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014226timeout <event> <time>
14227 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14228 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14229 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014230 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14231 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014232 Default value: 1s
14233 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014234 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014235 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014236 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14237 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14238
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014239 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014240
14241 resolvers mydns
14242 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14243 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014244 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014245 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014246 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014247 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014248 hold other 30s
14249 hold refused 30s
14250 hold nx 30s
14251 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014252 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014253 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014254
14255
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142566. Cache
14257---------
14258
14259HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14260(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14261RAM.
14262
14263The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14264this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14265
14266If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14267independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14268when we try to allocate a new one.
14269
14270The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14271
14272It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14273"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14274for more details.
14275
14276When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14277replaced by "<CACHE>".
14278
14279
142806.1. Limitation
14281----------------
14282
14283The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14284
14285- If the response is not a 200
14286- If the response contains a Vary header
14287- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14288- If the response is not cacheable
14289
14290- If the request is not a GET
14291- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14292- If the request contains an Authorization header
14293
14294
142956.2. Setup
14296-----------
14297
14298To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14299the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14300
14301
143026.2.1. Cache section
14303---------------------
14304
14305cache <name>
14306 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14307 size of cache is mandatory.
14308
14309total-max-size <megabytes>
14310 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14311 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14312
14313max-object-size <bytes>
14314 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14315 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14316 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14317
14318max-age <seconds>
14319 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14320 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14321 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14322 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14323 default.
14324
14325
143266.2.2. Proxy section
14327---------------------
14328
14329http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14330 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14331 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14332 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14333 after this one.
14334
14335http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14336 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14337 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14338 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14339 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14340
14341
14342Example:
14343
14344 backend bck1
14345 mode http
14346
14347 http-request cache-use foobar
14348 http-response cache-store foobar
14349 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14350
14351 cache foobar
14352 total-max-size 4
14353 max-age 240
14354
14355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143567. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14357----------------------------------
14358
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014359HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14361The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14362these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14363but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14364data called patterns.
14365
14366
143677.1. ACL basics
14368---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014369
14370The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14371content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14372from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14373simple :
14374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014375 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014376 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14378 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14381adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014382
14383In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014386
14387This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14388Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14389and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014390an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14391conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14392as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14393are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014394
14395ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14396'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14397which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14398
14399There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14400performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14403specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14404this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014405methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14406ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407
14408Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14409 - boolean
14410 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14411 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14412 - string
14413 - data block
14414
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014415Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14416converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14417would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14418The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14419which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14420
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014421Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14422keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14423fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14424which are summarized in the table below :
14425
14426 +---------------------+-----------------+
14427 | Sample or converter | Default |
14428 | output type | matching method |
14429 +---------------------+-----------------+
14430 | boolean | bool |
14431 +---------------------+-----------------+
14432 | integer | int |
14433 +---------------------+-----------------+
14434 | ip | ip |
14435 +---------------------+-----------------+
14436 | string | str |
14437 +---------------------+-----------------+
14438 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14439 +---------------------+-----------------+
14440
14441Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14442matching method, see below.
14443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14445 - boolean
14446 - integer or integer range
14447 - IP address / network
14448 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14449 - regular expression
14450 - hex block
14451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014452The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14453
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014454 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14455 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014457 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014458 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014459 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014460 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14463read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14464if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14465lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14466will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14467beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14468a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14469lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14470exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14471
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014472The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14473parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14474ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14475a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14476check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14477
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014478The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14479socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14480file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14483loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14484
14485 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14486
14487In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14488the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14489case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14490as well.
14491
14492The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14493sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14494do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14495methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14496is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014497obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14499default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14500that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14501string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14502
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014503The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14504By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14505string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14506resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14507server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014508waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014509flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14510function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14513sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14514be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014515
14516 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14517 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014518 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14519 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14520 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14521 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014522
14523 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14524 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014525 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014526
14527 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014529
14530 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014533 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014534 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14535
14536 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14537 binary or string samples.
14538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14540 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14543 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14544 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14547 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014549 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14550 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14553 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14556 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014557 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14560 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14561 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014562
14563For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14564request, it is possible to do :
14565
14566 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14567
14568In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14569buffer, one would use the following acl :
14570
14571 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14572
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014573On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14574possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14575
14576 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014578All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14579criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14580method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14581to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14582criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14583the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014586the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14587For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14590 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14591 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14592 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014593
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014594
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014595The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14596types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14597combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14598brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14599default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 +-------------------------------------------------+
14602 | Input sample type |
14603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014604 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14606 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014608 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014610 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014611 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014612 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014614 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014616 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014617 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014618 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014620 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014622 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014624 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014626 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014628 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14630 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014632
14633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146347.1.1. Matching booleans
14635------------------------
14636
14637In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14638Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14639When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14640that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14641
14642Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14643return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14644"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146477.1.2. Matching integers
14648------------------------
14649
14650Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14651enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14652to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14653
14654Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14655matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14656lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014657
14658For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14659unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14660representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14661
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014662As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14663two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14664instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14665ranges and operators.
14666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014667For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014668operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14669Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14670of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014672Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014673
14674 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14675 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14676 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14677 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14678 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14679
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014680For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014681
14682 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14683
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014684This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14685
14686 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146897.1.3. Matching strings
14690-----------------------
14691
14692String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14693different forms :
14694
14695 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014696 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014697
14698 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014699 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700
14701 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14702 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14703
14704 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14705 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14706
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014707 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14709 matches.
14710
14711 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14712 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14713 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014714
14715String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14716exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14717characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14718string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14719to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014720before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014721
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014722Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14723(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14724Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14725
14726Example:
14727 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14728 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147317.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14732---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014733
14734Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14735they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14736possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14737passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14738the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014739the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14740match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014741
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147437.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14744-------------------------------------
14745
14746It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14747not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14748a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14749to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14750digits may be used upper or lower case.
14751
14752Example :
14753 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14754 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14755
14756
147577.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14758---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014759
14760IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14761netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14762within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014763host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014764difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14765at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14766does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14767parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014768
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014769The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14770abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14771
14772 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14773 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14774 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14775 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14776 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14777 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14778 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14779 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14780
14781Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14782192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14783
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014784IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14785Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14786trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14787IPv6 patterns.
14788
14789HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14790following situations :
14791 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14792 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14793 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14794 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14795 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14796 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14797 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14798 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14799 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14800 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802
148037.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14804----------------------------------
14805
14806Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14807combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14808
14809 - AND (implicit)
14810 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14811 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14818indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14821"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14822requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14823is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14824
14825 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014826 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14827 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14828 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014829
14830To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14831and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14832
14833 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14834 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14835 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14836 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14837
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014838 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14840 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14841 use_backend www if host_www
14842
14843It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14844expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14845be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14846the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14847
14848 The following rule :
14849
14850 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014851 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852
14853 Can also be written that way :
14854
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014855 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856
14857It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14858to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14859simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14860sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14861good use is the following :
14862
14863 With named ACLs :
14864
14865 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14866 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14867 monitor fail if site_dead
14868
14869 With anonymous ACLs :
14870
14871 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14872
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014873See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14874keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875
14876
148777.3. Fetching samples
14878---------------------
14879
14880Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14881against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14882sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14883ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14884of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14885available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14886
14887This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14888Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14889compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14890deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14891
14892The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14893matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14894method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14895indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14896
14897As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14898when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14899mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14900the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14901ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14902
14903Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14904multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14905when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014906incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14907are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14909all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14910
14911Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14912 - name
14913 - name(arg1)
14914 - name(arg1,arg2)
14915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014916
149177.3.1. Converters
14918-----------------
14919
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014920Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14921of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14922is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14923was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014924has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014925unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14926
14927These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14928sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14929the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014930support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014932A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14933support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14934supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14935(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14936bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014939
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001494051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14941 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14942 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14943 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14944 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14945 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14946
14947 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014948 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14949 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014950 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14951 frontend http-in
14952 bind *:8081
14953 default_backend servers
14954 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14955 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14956
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014957add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014958 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014959 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014960 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14961 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014962 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014963 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14964 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14965 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14966 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014967 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014968 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014969
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014970aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14971 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14972 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14973 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14974 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14975 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14976 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14977
14978 Example:
14979 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14980 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14981
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014982and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014983 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014984 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014985 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14986 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014987 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014988 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14989 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014993 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014994
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014995b64dec
14996 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14997 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14998
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014999base64
15000 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015001 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015002 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15003
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015004bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015005 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015006 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015007 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015008 presence of a flag).
15009
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015010bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15011 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15012 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015013 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015014
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015015concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15016 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15017 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15018 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15019 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15020 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15021 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15022 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15023 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15024 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15025 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015026 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015027 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015028 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15029 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015030
15031 Example:
15032 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15033 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15034 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015035 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015036 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15037
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015038cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015039 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15040 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015041
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015042crc32([<avalanche>])
15043 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15044 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15045 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15046 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15047 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15048 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15049 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15050 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15051 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15052 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015053 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15054
15055crc32c([<avalanche>])
15056 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15057 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15058 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15059 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15060 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15061 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15062 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15063 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015064
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015065cut_crlf
15066 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15067 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15068 updated.
15069
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015070da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015071 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15072 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15073 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15074 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015075 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015076 configuration language.
15077
15078 Example:
15079 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015080 bind *:8881
15081 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015082 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015083
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015084debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15085 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15086 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15087 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15088 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15089 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15090 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15091 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15092 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15093 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15094 printable sample types.
15095
15096 Example:
15097 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015098
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015099digest(<algorithm>)
15100 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15101 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15102
15103 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15104 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15105
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015106div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015107 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15108 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015109 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015110 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15111 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015112 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015113 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15114 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15116 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015118 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015119
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015120djb2([<avalanche>])
15121 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15122 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15123 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15124 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15125 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15126 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15127 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015128 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15129 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015130
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015131even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015132 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015133 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15134
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015135field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15136 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15137 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15138 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15139 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15140 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15141 fields.
15142
15143 Example :
15144 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15146 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15147 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15148 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015149
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015150fix_is_valid
15151 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15152 Information eXchange):
15153
15154 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15155 numeric
15156 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15157 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15158 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15159 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15160 checksum
15161
15162 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15163 the server can be parsed.
15164
15165 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15166 message, false if not.
15167
15168 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15169
15170 Example:
15171 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15172 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15173
15174fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15175 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15176 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15177 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15178 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15179 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15180 added.
15181
15182 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15183 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15184 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15185 fix_is_valid converter.
15186
15187 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15188
15189 Example:
15190 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15191 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15192 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15193 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15194 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015196hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015197 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015198 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015199 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015200 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015201
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015202hex2i
15203 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015204 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015205
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015206htonl
15207 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15208 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15209 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15210 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15211
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015212hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15213 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15214 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15215 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15216 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15217
15218 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15219 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15220
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015221http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015222 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15223 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015224 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15225 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15226 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15227 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15228 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15229 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15230 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15231 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015233iif(<true>,<false>)
15234 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15235 string otherwise.
15236
15237 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015238 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015239
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015240in_table(<table>)
15241 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15242 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15243 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015245 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15246
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015247ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15248 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015249 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015250 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15251 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15252 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15253 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15254 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015255
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015256json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015257 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015258 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015259 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015260 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15261 of errors:
15262 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15263 bytes, ...)
15264 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15265 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15266
15267 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15268 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15269 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15270 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15271 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15272 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015273 - "ascii" : never fails;
15274 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15275 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015276 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015277 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015278 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15279 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15280
15281 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015282 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015283
15284 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015285 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015286 capture request header user-agent len 150
15287 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015288
15289 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15290 GET / HTTP/1.0
15291 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15292
15293 Output log:
15294 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15295
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015296language(<value>[,<default>])
15297 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15298 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15299 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15300 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15301 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15302 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15303 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15304 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15305 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015307 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15308 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015310 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015312 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15313 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015315 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15316 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15317 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15318 use_backend spanish if es
15319 use_backend french if fr
15320 use_backend english if en
15321 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015322
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015323length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015324 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15325 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15326 type. The result is of type integer.
15327
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015328lower
15329 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15330 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15331 type. The result is of type string.
15332
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015333ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15334 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15335 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15336 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15337 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15338 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15339 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15340
15341 Example :
15342
15343 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015344 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015345 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15346
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015347ltrim(<chars>)
15348 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15349 representation of the input sample.
15350
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015351map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15352map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15353map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15354 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15355 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15356 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15357 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15358 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15359 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15360 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15361 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015362
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015363 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15364 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15365 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015366
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015367 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015368 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015369
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015370 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15371 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15372 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15373 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015374 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15375 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015376 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15377 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15378 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15379 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15380 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15381 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15382 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15383 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015384 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15385 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15386 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015387 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15388 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15389 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15390 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15391 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015392
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015393 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15394 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15395 the corresponding match text.
15396
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015397 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15398 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15399 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15400 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15401 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015402
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015403 Example :
15404
15405 # this is a comment and is ignored
15406 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15407 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15408 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15409 | | | `---------- value
15410 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15411 | `---------------------------- key
15412 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15413
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015414mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015415 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15416 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015417 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015418 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015419 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015420 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15421 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15422 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15423 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015424 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015425 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015426
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015427mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15428 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15429 <packettype>.
15430 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15431 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15432 from.
15433 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15434 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15435 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15436
15437 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15438 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15439 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15440 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15441
15442 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15443 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15444 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15445 packets only):
15446 17: Session Expiry Interval
15447 33: Receive Maximum
15448 39: Maximum Packet Size
15449 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15450 25: Request Response Information
15451 23: Request Problem Information
15452 21: Authentication Method
15453 22: Authentication Data
15454 18: Will Delay Interval
15455 1: Payload Format Indicator
15456 2: Message Expiry Interval
15457 3: Content Type
15458 8: Response Topic
15459 9: Correlation Data
15460 Not supported yet:
15461 38: User Property
15462
15463 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15464 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15465 packets only):
15466 17: Session Expiry Interval
15467 33: Receive Maximum
15468 36: Maximum QoS
15469 37: Retain Available
15470 39: Maximum Packet Size
15471 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15472 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15473 31: Reason String
15474 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15475 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15476 42: Shared Subscription Available
15477 19: Server Keep Alive
15478 26: Response Information
15479 28: Server Reference
15480 21: Authentication Method
15481 22: Authentication Data
15482 Not supported yet:
15483 38: User Property
15484
15485 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15486 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15487 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15488 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15489
15490 Example:
15491
15492 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15493 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15494 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15495 if data_in_buffer
15496 # do the same as above
15497 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15498 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15499 if data_in_buffer
15500
15501mqtt_is_valid
15502 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15503
15504 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15505 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15506 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15507 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15508
15509 Example:
15510
15511 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15512 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15513
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015514mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015515 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015516 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15517 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015518 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015519 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015520 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015521 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15522 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15523 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15524 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015525 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015526 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015527
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015528nbsrv
15529 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15530 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15531 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15532 map lookup.
15533
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015534neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015535 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15536 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15537 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15538 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015539
15540not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015541 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015542 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015543 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015544 absence of a flag).
15545
15546odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015547 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015548 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15549
15550or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015551 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015552 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015553 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15554 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015555 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015556 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15557 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15558 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15559 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015561 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015562
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015563protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15564 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15565 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15566 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15567 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15568 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15569 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15570 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15571 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15572 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15573 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15574 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15575
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015576regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015577 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15578 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15579 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15580 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15581 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15582 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15583 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15584 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15585 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015586 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15587 of characters with other ones.
15588
15589 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15590 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15591 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15592 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15593 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15594 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015595
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015596 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015597
15598 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15599 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15600 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015601 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015602
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015603 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15604 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15605
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015606 # capture groups and backreferences
15607 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015608 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015609 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15610
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015611capture-req(<id>)
15612 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15613 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15614
15615 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015616 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15617 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015618
15619capture-res(<id>)
15620 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15621 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15622
15623 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015624 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15625 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015626
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015627rtrim(<chars>)
15628 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15629 of the input sample.
15630
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015631sdbm([<avalanche>])
15632 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15633 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15634 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15635 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15636 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15637 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15638 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015639 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15640 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015641
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015642secure_memcmp(<var>)
15643 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15644 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15645 match.
15646
15647 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15648 performed in constant time.
15649
15650 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15651 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15652
15653 Example :
15654
15655 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15656 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15657 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15658 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15659
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015660set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015661 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15662 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15663 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015667 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015668 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15669 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015671 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015672
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015673sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015674 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015675 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15676
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015677sha2([<bits>])
15678 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15679 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15680
15681 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15682 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15683
15684 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15685 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15686
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015687srv_queue
15688 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15689 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15690 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15691 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15692 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15693
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015694strcmp(<var>)
15695 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15696 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15697 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15698 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15699 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15700 shorter).
15701
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015702 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15703 strings in constant time.
15704
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015705 Example :
15706
15707 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15708 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15709 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15710
15711
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015712sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015713 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15714 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015715 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015716 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15717 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015718 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015719 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15720 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015721 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015722 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15723 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015724 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015725 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015726
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015727table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15731 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15732 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15733 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15734
15735
15736table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15740 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15741 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15742 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15743
15744table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15745 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15746 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015747 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015748 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15749 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15750
15751table_conn_cur(<table>)
15752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15754 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15755 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15756 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15757
15758table_conn_rate(<table>)
15759 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15760 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15761 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15762 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15763 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15764
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015765table_gpt0(<table>)
15766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15769 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15770 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15771
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015772table_gpc0(<table>)
15773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15776 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15777 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15778
15779table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15782 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15783 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15784 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15785 sample fetch keyword.
15786
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015787table_gpc1(<table>)
15788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15791 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15792 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15793
15794table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15795 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15796 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15797 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15798 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15799 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15800 sample fetch keyword.
15801
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015802table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15803 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15804 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015805 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015806 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15807 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15808
15809table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15812 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15813 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15814 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15815 keyword.
15816
15817table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015821 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15822 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15823
15824table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15825 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15826 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15827 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15828 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15829 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15830 keyword.
15831
15832table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15833 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15834 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015835 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015836 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15837 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15838 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15839 keyword.
15840
15841table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015845 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15846 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15847 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15848 keyword.
15849
15850table_server_id(<table>)
15851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15854 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15855 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15856 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15857
15858table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015862 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15863 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15864 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15865 keyword.
15866
15867table_sess_rate(<table>)
15868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15871 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15872 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15873 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15874 keyword.
15875
15876table_trackers(<table>)
15877 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15878 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15879 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15880 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15881 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15882 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15883 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15884 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15885 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15886 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15887
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015888upper
15889 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15890 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15891 type. The result is of type string.
15892
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015893url_dec([<in_form>])
15894 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15895 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15896 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15897 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15898 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15899 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015900
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015901ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015902 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015903 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15904 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15905 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015906 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15907 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15908 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15909 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015910 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015911 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15912 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015913
15914 Example:
15915 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15916 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15917
15918 message Point {
15919 int32 latitude = 1;
15920 int32 longitude = 2;
15921 }
15922
15923 message PPoint {
15924 Point point = 59;
15925 }
15926
15927 message Rectangle {
15928 // One corner of the rectangle.
15929 PPoint lo = 48;
15930 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15931 PPoint hi = 49;
15932 }
15933
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015934 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15935 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15936 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015937
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015938 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15939 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015940 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015941 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15942
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015943 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015944
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015945 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015946
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015947 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15948 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15949 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015950
15951 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15952 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15953 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15954
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015955 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15956 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15957 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015958
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015959
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015960unset-var(<var name>)
15961 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15962 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15963 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15964 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15965 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15966 response),
15967 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15968 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15969 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15970 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15971
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015972utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15973 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15974 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15975 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15976 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15977 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15978 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15979
15980 Example :
15981
15982 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015984 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15985
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015986word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15987 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15988 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15989 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015990 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015991 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15992 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15993
15994 Example :
15995 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15996 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15997 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15998 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15999 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016000 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016001
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016002wt6([<avalanche>])
16003 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16004 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16005 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16006 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16007 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16008 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16009 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016010 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16011 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016012
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016013xor(<value>)
16014 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016015 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016016 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016017 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016018 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016019 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16020 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016021 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016022 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16023 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016025 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016026
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016027xxh32([<seed>])
16028 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16029 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16030 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16031 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16032 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16033 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16034 as cryptographically secure.
16035
16036xxh64([<seed>])
16037 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16038 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16039 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16040 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16041 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16042 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16043 as cryptographically secure.
16044
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160467.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047--------------------------------------------
16048
16049A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16050not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16051"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16052The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16053
16054always_false : boolean
16055 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16056 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16057
16058always_true : boolean
16059 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16060 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16061
16062avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016063 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16065 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16066 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16067 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16068 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16069 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16070 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16071 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16072 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16073 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16074 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16075 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16076 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016079 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16080 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16081 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16082 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016083 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16084
16085be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16087 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16088 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16089 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16090 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016091 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16092 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016093
16094 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16095 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16096 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16100 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16101 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16104 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016105
16106 Example :
16107 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16108 backend dynamic
16109 mode http
16110 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16111 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016113bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016114 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16115 of the string.
16116
16117bool(<bool>) : bool
16118 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16119 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16122 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016123 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16125 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016126
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016127 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016128 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016129 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16130
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016131 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16132 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016133
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016134 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016135 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016137 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016138 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016140 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016141
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016142 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16143 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016145 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016146
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016147cpu_calls : integer
16148 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16149 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16150 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16151 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16152 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16153 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16154
16155cpu_ns_avg : integer
16156 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16157 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16158 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16159 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16160 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16161 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16162 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16163 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16164 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16165 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16166 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16167
16168cpu_ns_tot : integer
16169 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16170 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16171 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16172 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16173 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16174 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16175 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16176 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16177 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16178 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16179 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16180 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16181 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16182
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016183date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016184 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016185
16186 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16187 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16188 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016189 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16190
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016191 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16192 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16193 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16194 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16195 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16196
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016197 Example :
16198
16199 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16200 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016201
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016202 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16203 # millisecond granularity
16204 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16205
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016206date_us : integer
16207 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16208 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16209 from the same timeval structure.
16210
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016211distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16212 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16213 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16214 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16215 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16216 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16217 list of supported tokens.
16218
16219distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16220 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16221 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16222 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16223 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16224 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16225 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16226 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16227 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16228 supported tokens.
16229
16230 Example :
16231 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16232 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16233 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16234 # send large files to the big farm
16235 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16236
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016237env(<name>) : string
16238 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16239 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16240 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16241 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16242 certain way.
16243
16244 Examples :
16245 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16246 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16247
16248 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16249 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16252 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016253 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16254 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016255 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16256 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016257 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16259 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016260
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016261fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16262 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16263 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16264 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16268 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16269 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16270 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16271 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16272 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16273 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16274 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016275
16276 Example :
16277 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16278 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16279 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16280 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16281 frontend mail
16282 bind :25
16283 mode tcp
16284 maxconn 100
16285 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16286 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16287 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16288 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016289
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016290hostname : string
16291 Returns the system hostname.
16292
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016293int(<integer>) : signed integer
16294 Returns a signed integer.
16295
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016296ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16297 Returns an ipv4.
16298
16299ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16300 Returns an ipv6.
16301
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016302lat_ns_avg : integer
16303 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16304 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16305 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16306 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16307 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16308 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16309 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16310 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16311 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016312 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16313 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16314 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16315 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16316 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16317 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016318
16319lat_ns_tot : integer
16320 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16321 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16322 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16323 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16324 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16325 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16326 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16327 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16328 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016329 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16330 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16331 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16332 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16333 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016334 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16335 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16336 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16337 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16338 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16339 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16340
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016341meth(<method>) : method
16342 Returns a method.
16343
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016344nbproc : integer
16345 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16346 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16347 and debugging purposes.
16348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016349nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16350 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16351 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16352 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016353 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16354 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16355 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016356
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016357prio_class : integer
16358 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16359 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16360 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16361
16362prio_offset : integer
16363 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16364 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16365 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16366 set-priority-offset".
16367
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016368proc : integer
16369 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16370 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16371 debugging purposes.
16372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016374 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16375 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16376 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16378 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16379 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16380 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16381 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16382
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016383rand([<range>]) : integer
16384 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16385 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16386 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16387 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16388 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16389
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016390uuid([<version>]) : string
16391 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16392 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16393 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16397 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16398 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16399 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16400 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016401 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16402 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16403
16404srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16406 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16407 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16408 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16409 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16410 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16411 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16412
16413 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16414 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415
16416srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16417 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16418 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16419 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016420 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16422 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16423 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16424
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016425srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16427 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16428 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16429 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16430 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16431 fetch methods.
16432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16434 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16435 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016436 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16438 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016439 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016440 overloading servers).
16441
16442 Example :
16443 # Redirect to a separate back
16444 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16445 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16446 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16447
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016448srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16449 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16450 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16451 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16452
16453srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16454 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16455 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16456 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16457
16458srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16459 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16460 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16461 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16462
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016463stopping : boolean
16464 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16465 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16466 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16467
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016468str(<string>) : string
16469 Returns a string.
16470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16472 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16473 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16474
16475table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16476 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16477 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16478 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16479
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016480thread : integer
16481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16482 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16483 and debugging purposes.
16484
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016485var(<var-name>) : undefined
16486 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016487 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16488 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16491 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016492 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016493 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16494 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016495 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016496 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499----------------------------------
16500
16501The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16502closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16503methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16504sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16505TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016506the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16507counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016508"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16509used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16510can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16511Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16512table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16513tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16514currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016516bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016517 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16518 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16519 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016521be_id : integer
16522 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016523 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16524 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016526be_name : string
16527 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016528 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16529 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531dst : ip
16532 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16533 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16534 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16535 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016536 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16537 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16538 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16539 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16540 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16541 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542
16543dst_conn : integer
16544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16545 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16546 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16547 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16548 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16549 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16550 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16551 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016552
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016553dst_is_local : boolean
16554 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16555 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16556 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16557 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016558 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016559 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16560 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16561 it only once per connection.
16562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016563dst_port : integer
16564 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16565 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16566 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16567 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16568 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16569 an HTTP header.
16570
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016571fc_http_major : integer
16572 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16573 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16574 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16575
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016576fc_pp_authority : string
16577 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16578 if any.
16579
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016580fc_pp_unique_id : string
16581 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16582 if any.
16583
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016584fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16585 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16586 header.
16587
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016588fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16589 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16590 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16591 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16592 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16593 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16594 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16595
16596fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16597 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16598 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16599 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16600 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16601 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16602 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16603
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016604fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016605 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16606 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16607 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16608 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16609
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016610fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016611 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16612 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16613 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16614 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16615
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016616fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016617 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16618 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16619 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16620 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16621
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016622fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016623 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16624 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16625 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16626 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16627
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016628fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016629 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16630 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16631 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16632 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16633
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016634fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016635 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16636 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16637 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16638 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16639
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016640fe_defbe : string
16641 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16642 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644fe_id : integer
16645 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016646 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16648
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016649fe_name : string
16650 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16651 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16652 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016654sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016655sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16656sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16657sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016658 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16659 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16660 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016662sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016663sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16664sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16665sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016666 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16667 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16668 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016670sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016671sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16672sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16673sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016674 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16675 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016676 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16677 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16678 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016679
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016680 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016681 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16682 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016683 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16684 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16685 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016686 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16687 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16688
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016689sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16690sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16691sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16692sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16693 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16694 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16695 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16696 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16697 when a first ACL was verified.
16698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016699sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016700sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16701sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16702sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016703 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016704 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16705
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016706sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016707sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16708sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16709sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16711 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16712 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016714sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016715sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16716sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16717sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016718 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16719 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16720 See also src_conn_rate.
16721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016722sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016723sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16724sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16725sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016726 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016727 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016728
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016729sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16730sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16731sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16732sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16733 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16734 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16735
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016736sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16737sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16738sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16739sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16740 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16741 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016743sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016744sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16745sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16746sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016747 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16748 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16749 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016750 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16751 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16752 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016753
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016754sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16755sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16756sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16757sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16758 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16759 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16760 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16761 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16762 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16763 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016765sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016766sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16767sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16768sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016769 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016770 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16771 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016773sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016774sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16775sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16776sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016777 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16778 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16779 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16780 src_http_err_rate.
16781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016782sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016783sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16784sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16785sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016786 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016787 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16788 src_http_req_cnt.
16789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016790sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016791sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16792sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16793sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016794 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16795 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16796 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16797 src_http_req_rate.
16798
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016799sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016800sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16801sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16802sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016803 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016804 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16805 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16806 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16807 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016808
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016809 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016810 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16811 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016812 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16813
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016814sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16815sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16816sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16817sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16818 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16819 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16820 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16821 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16822 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016824sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016825sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16826sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16827sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016828 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16829 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16830 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016832sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016833sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16834sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16835sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016836 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16837 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16838 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016840sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016841sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16842sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16843sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016844 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016845 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16846 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16847 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016848 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016849 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16850
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016851sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016852sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16853sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16854sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016855 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16856 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16857 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16858 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16859 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016860 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016862sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016863sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16864sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16865sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016866 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16867 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16868 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016870sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016871sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16872sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16873sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016874 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16875 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016876 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016877 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16878 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16880 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16881 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883so_id : integer
16884 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16885 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16886 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016887
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016888so_name : string
16889 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16890 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16891 strings instead of integers.
16892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016894 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16896 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16897 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016898 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16899 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16900 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016901 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16902 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16903 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16904 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16905 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16906 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16907 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016908
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016909 Example:
16910 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16911 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16914 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16915 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16916 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016917 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16920 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16921 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016922 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016923 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16926 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16927 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16928 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16929 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16930 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16931 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016932
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016933 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016934 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16935 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16936 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16937 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016938 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016939 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16940 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16941
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016942src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16943 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16944 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16945 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16946 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16947 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16948 was verified.
16949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016950src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016951 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016952 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016953 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016954 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016956src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016957 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16959 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016960 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016962src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16963 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16964 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16965 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016966 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016969 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016971 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016972 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016974src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16975 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16976 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16977 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16978 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016980src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16981 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16982 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16983 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16984 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016986src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016987 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016989 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16990 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016991 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16992 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16993 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016994
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016995src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16996 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16997 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16998 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16999 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17000 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17001 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17002 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017005 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017006 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017007 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017008 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017009 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17012 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17013 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17014 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17015 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017016 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017018src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017019 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017020 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17021 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017022 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17025 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17026 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17027 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017028 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017029 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017031src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17032 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17033 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17034 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017035 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17037 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017038
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017039 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017040 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017041 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017042 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017043
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017044src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17045 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17046 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17047 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17048 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17049 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17050 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17051
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017052src_is_local : boolean
17053 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17054 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17055 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17056 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017057 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017058 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17059 once per connection.
17060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017061src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017062 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17063 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17064 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17065 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17066 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017069 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17070 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17071 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17072 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17073 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075src_port : integer
17076 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17077 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17078 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17079 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017082 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017083 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17084 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17085 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017086 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017088src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17089 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17090 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17091 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17092 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017093 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017095src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17096 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17097 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17098 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17099 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17100 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17101 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17102 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17103 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017104
17105 Example :
17106 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17107 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17108 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17109 listen ssh
17110 bind :22
17111 mode tcp
17112 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017113 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017115 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117srv_id : integer
17118 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17119 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017120 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017121
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017122srv_name : string
17123 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17124 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017125 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171277.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17131closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17132when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17133usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017134future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017135
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001713651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17137 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17138 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17139 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17140 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17141 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17142
17143 Example :
17144 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17145 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17146 # the request.
17147 frontend http-in
17148 bind *:8081
17149 default_backend servers
17150 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17151 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17152
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017153ssl_bc : boolean
17154 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17155 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017156 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17157 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017158
17159ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17160 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017161 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17162 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017163
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017164ssl_bc_alpn : string
17165 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17166 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017167 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017168 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17169 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17170 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17171 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17172 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017173 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17174 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017175
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017176ssl_bc_cipher : string
17177 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017178 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17179 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017180
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017181ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17182 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17183 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17184 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017185 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017186
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017187ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17188 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17189 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017190 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17191 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017192
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017193ssl_bc_npn : string
17194 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17195 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017196 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017197 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17198 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17199 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17200 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017201 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17202 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017203
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017204ssl_bc_protocol : string
17205 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017206 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17207 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017208
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017209ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017210 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017211 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017212 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17213 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017214
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017215ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17216 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17217 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17218 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017219 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017220
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017221ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17222 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17223 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017224 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17225 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017226
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017227ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17228 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17229 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17230 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017231 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017232
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017233ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17234 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017235 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17236 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17239 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17240 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17241 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17242 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17243 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17246 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17247 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17248 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17249 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017250
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017251ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017252 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17253 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17254 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17255 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17256 does not support resumed sessions.
17257
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017258ssl_c_der : binary
17259 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17260 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17261 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263ssl_c_err : integer
17264 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17265 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17266 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17267 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17268 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017269
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017270ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17272 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17273 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17274 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17275 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17276 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17277 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17278 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017279 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17280 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17281 LDAP v3.
17282 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17283 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285ssl_c_key_alg : string
17286 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17287 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17288 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290ssl_c_notafter : string
17291 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17292 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17293 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017295ssl_c_notbefore : string
17296 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17297 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17298 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017299
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017300ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17302 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17303 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17304 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17305 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17306 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17307 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17308 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017309 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17310 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17311 LDAP v3.
17312 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17313 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315ssl_c_serial : binary
17316 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17317 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17318 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17321 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17322 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17323 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017324 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17325 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17326
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017327 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017328 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17331 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17332 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17333 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335ssl_c_used : boolean
17336 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17337 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339ssl_c_verify : integer
17340 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17341 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17342 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17343 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345ssl_c_version : integer
17346 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17347 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017348
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017349ssl_f_der : binary
17350 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17351 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17352 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17353
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017354ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17356 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17357 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17358 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017359 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17361 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17362 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017363 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17364 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17365 LDAP v3.
17366 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17367 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017369ssl_f_key_alg : string
17370 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17371 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17372 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017374ssl_f_notafter : string
17375 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17376 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17377 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379ssl_f_notbefore : string
17380 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17381 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17382 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017383
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017384ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17386 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17387 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17388 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17389 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17390 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17391 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17392 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017393 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17394 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17395 LDAP v3.
17396 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17397 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399ssl_f_serial : binary
17400 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17401 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17402 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017403
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017404ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17405 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17406 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17407 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17410 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17411 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17412 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414ssl_f_version : integer
17415 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17416 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17417
17418ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017419 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17420 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17421 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423 Example :
17424 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17425 listen http-https
17426 bind :80
17427 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17428 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17429
17430ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17431 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17432 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17433
17434ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017435 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017436 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17437 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17438 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17439 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17440 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17441 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17442 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17443 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445ssl_fc_cipher : string
17446 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17447 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017448
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017449ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17450 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17451 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017452 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017453
17454ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17455 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17456 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017457 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017458
17459ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17460 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17461 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17462 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017463 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017464 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017465
17466ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17467 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17468 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017469 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017470
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017471ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17472 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17473 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17474 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17475
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017476ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17477 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17478 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17479 transport layer.
17480 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17481 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17482 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17483 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17484
17485ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17486 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17487 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17488 transport layer.
17489 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17490 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17491 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17492 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17493
17494ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17495 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17496 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17497 transport layer.
17498 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17499 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17500 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17501 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17502
17503ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17504 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17505 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17506 transport layer.
17507 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17508 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17509 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17510 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17511
17512ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17513 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17514 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17515 transport layer.
17516 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17517 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17518 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17519 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017522 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17523 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017524 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17525 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17526 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17527 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017528
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017529ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17530 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17531 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17532 wait until the handshake happened.
17533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017534ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17535 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017536 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17537 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017538 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017539 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017540
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017541ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017542 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017543 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17544 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017547 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17549 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17550 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17551 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17552 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17553 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17554 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556ssl_fc_protocol : string
17557 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17558 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017559
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017560ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017561 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017562 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17563 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017564
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017565ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17566 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17567 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17568 transport layer.
17569 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17570 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17571 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17572 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17573
17574ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17575 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17576 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17577 transport layer.
17578 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17579 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17580 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17581 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17582
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017583ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17584 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17585 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17586 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17589 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17590 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17591 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17592 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017593
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017594ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17595 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17596 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17597 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17598 BoringSSL.
17599
17600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601ssl_fc_sni : string
17602 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17603 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17604 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17605 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17606 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17607
17608 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17609 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17610 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017611 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017612 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17616 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017618ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17619 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17620 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017621
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017622ssl_s_der : binary
17623 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17624 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17625 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17626
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017627ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17628 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17629 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17630 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17631 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17632 does not support resumed sessions.
17633
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017634ssl_s_key_alg : string
17635 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17636 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17637 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17638
17639ssl_s_notafter : string
17640 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17641 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17642 transport layer.
17643
17644ssl_s_notbefore : string
17645 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17646 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17647 transport layer.
17648
17649ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17650 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17651 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17652 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17653 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17654 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17655 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017656 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17657 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017658 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17659 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17660 LDAP v3.
17661 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17662 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17663
17664ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17665 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17666 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17667 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17668 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17669 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17670 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017671 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17672 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017673 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17674 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17675 LDAP v3.
17676 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17677 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17678
17679ssl_s_serial : binary
17680 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17681 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17682 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17683
17684ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17685 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17686 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17687 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17688
17689ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17690 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17691 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17692 layer.
17693
17694ssl_s_version : integer
17695 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17696 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176987.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17702sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17703only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17704For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17705be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17706can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17707sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17708for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17709content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017712 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17714 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17717 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017718 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017719 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017720
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017721req.hdrs : string
17722 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17723 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17724 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17725 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17726
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017727req.hdrs_bin : binary
17728 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17729 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17730 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17731 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17732 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17733 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17734
17735 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17736
17737 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17738 str: <int:length><bytes>
17739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740req.len : integer
17741req_len : integer (deprecated)
17742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17743 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17744 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17745 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17746 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17747 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17748 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17749 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017751req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17752 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017753 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17754 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17755 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17756 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758 ACL alternatives :
17759 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17762 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17763 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17764 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17765 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767 ACL alternatives :
17768 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017770 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017772req.proto_http : boolean
17773req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17774 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17775 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17776 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17777 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17778 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17779 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17780 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782 Example:
17783 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17784 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17785 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017786 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017788req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17789rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17790 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17791 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17792 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17793 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17794 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17795 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17796 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17799 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17800 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17801 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17802 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17803 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017805 ACL derivatives :
17806 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017808 Example :
17809 listen tse-farm
17810 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17811 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17812 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17813 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17814 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17815 persist rdp-cookie
17816 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17817 # This is only useful makes sense if
17818 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17819 stick-table type string size 204800
17820 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17821 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17822 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17825 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17828rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17829 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17830 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17831 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17832 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017834 ACL derivatives :
17835 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017836
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017837req.ssl_alpn : string
17838 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17839 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17840 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17841 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17842 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17843 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017844 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017845
17846 Examples :
17847 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17848 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17849 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017850 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017851 default_backend bk_default
17852
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017853req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17854 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17855 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017856 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17857 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17858 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17859 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17860 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017862req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17863req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17864 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17865 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17866 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17867 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17868 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17869 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17870 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017872req.ssl_sni : string
17873req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17874 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17875 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17876 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17877 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17878 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017879 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17880 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17881 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17882 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17883 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17884 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17885 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17886 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17887 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017889 ACL derivatives :
17890 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892 Examples :
17893 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17894 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17895 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17896 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17897 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017898
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017899req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17900 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17901 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17902 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17903 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17904 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17905 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17906 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17907 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17908 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017910req.ssl_ver : integer
17911req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17912 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17913 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17914 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17915 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17916 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17917 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17918 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017919 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017922 ACL derivatives :
17923 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017924
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017925res.len : integer
17926 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17927 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17928 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17929 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17930 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17931 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17932 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017933 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017935res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17936 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017937 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017938 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017939 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017940 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17943 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17944 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17945 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017946 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17947 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017950
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017951res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17952rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17953 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17954 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17955 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17956 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17957 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17958 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17959 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961wait_end : boolean
17962 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17963 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017964 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17966 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017967 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017968 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17969 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971 Examples :
17972 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17973 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17974 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17977 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17978 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17979 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17980 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17981 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17982 tcp-request content reject
17983
17984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179857.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017986--------------------------------------
17987
17988It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17989This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17990data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17991its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17992HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17993content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17994to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17995more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17996response are indexed.
17997
17998base : string
17999 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18000 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18001 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18002 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18003 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18004 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18005 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18006 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18007
18008 ACL derivatives :
18009 base : exact string match
18010 base_beg : prefix match
18011 base_dir : subdir match
18012 base_dom : domain match
18013 base_end : suffix match
18014 base_len : length match
18015 base_reg : regex match
18016 base_sub : substring match
18017
18018base32 : integer
18019 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18020 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18021 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018022 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18023 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18024 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025
18026base32+src : binary
18027 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18028 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18029 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18030 per-URL counters.
18031
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018032capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18033 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18034 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18035 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18036
18037capture.req.method : string
18038 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18039 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18040 because it's allocated.
18041
18042capture.req.uri : string
18043 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18044 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18045 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18046 allocated.
18047
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018048capture.req.ver : string
18049 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18050 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18051 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18052
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018053capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18054 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18055 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18056 The first entry is an index of 0.
18057 See also: "capture response header"
18058
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018059capture.res.ver : string
18060 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18061 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18062 persistent flag.
18063
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018064req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018065 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18066 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18067 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018068
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018069req.body_param([<name>) : string
18070 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18071 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18072 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18073 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18074 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18075 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18076 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18077 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18078 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18079 given.
18080
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018081req.body_len : integer
18082 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18083 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018084 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18085 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018086
18087req.body_size : integer
18088 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018089 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18090 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018092req.cook([<name>]) : string
18093cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18094 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18095 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18096 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18097 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18098 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18099 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18100 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18101 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18102
18103 ACL derivatives :
18104 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18105 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18106 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18107 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18108 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18109 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18110 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18111 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18114cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18115 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18116 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18119cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18120 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18121 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18122 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18123 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18126 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18127 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18128 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18129 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018130 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18132 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18133 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18134 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018136hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18137 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18138 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18139 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18140 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018141 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018143req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18144 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18145 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18146 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18147 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18148 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18149 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18150 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18151 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018153req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18154 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18155 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18156 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18157 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18160 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18161 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18162 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18163 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18164 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18165 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18166 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18167 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018168 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018169 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018170 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172 ACL derivatives :
18173 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18174 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18175 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18176 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18177 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18178 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18179 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18180 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18181
18182req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18183hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18184 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18185 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18186 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18187 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18188 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18189 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18190 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18191 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18192 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18193
18194req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18195hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18196 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18197 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18198 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18199 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18200 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018202 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18203 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18204
18205req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18206hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18207 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18208 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18209 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18210 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18211 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18212 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18213 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18214
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018215
18216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18218 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18219 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18220 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18221 basic auth is supported.
18222
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018223http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18224 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18225 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18226 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18227 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18229 basic auth is supported.
18230
18231 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018232 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18233 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18234 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18235 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018236
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018237http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018238 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18239 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18240 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018241
18242http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018243 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18244 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18245 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018246
18247http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018248 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18249 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18250 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018253 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18254 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18256 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018258method : integer + string
18259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18260 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18261 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18262 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18263 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18264 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18265 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267 ACL derivatives :
18268 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270 Example :
18271 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18272 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18273 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275path : string
18276 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18277 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18278 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18279 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18280 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018281 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 ACL derivatives :
18285 path : exact string match
18286 path_beg : prefix match
18287 path_dir : subdir match
18288 path_dom : domain match
18289 path_end : suffix match
18290 path_len : length match
18291 path_reg : regex match
18292 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018293
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018294pathq : string
18295 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18296 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18297 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18298 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18299 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18300 result in both cases.
18301
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018302query : string
18303 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18304 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18305 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18306 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018307 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018308 which stops before the question mark.
18309
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018310req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18311 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18312 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18313 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18314 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316req.ver : string
18317req_ver : string (deprecated)
18318 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18319 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18320 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018322 ACL derivatives :
18323 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018324
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018325res.body : binary
18326 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18327 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18328 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18329 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18330
18331res.body_len : integer
18332 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18333 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18334 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18335 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18336
18337res.body_size : integer
18338 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18339 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18340 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18341 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18342 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18343 based expect rules.
18344
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018345res.cache_hit : boolean
18346 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18347 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18348
18349res.cache_name : string
18350 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18351 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18352 empty string.
18353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018354res.comp : boolean
18355 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18356 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18357 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359res.comp_algo : string
18360 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18361 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18362 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018364res.cook([<name>]) : string
18365scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18366 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18367 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018368 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18369 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371 ACL derivatives :
18372 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18375scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18376 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18377 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018378 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18379 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18382scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18383 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18384 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018385 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18386 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18389 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18390 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18391 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18392 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18393 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18394 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18395 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18396 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018397 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18400 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18401 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18402 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18403 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018404 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18405 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18408shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18409 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18410 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18411 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18412 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18413 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18414 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18415 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018416 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18417 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018419 ACL derivatives :
18420 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18421 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18422 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18423 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18424 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18425 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18426 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18427 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18428
18429res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18430shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18431 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18432 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18433 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18434 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018435 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18438shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18439 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18440 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18441 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18442 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18443 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018444 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18445 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018446
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018447res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18448 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18449 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18450 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018451 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18452 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18455shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18456 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18457 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18458 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18459 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18460 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018461 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18462 based expect rules.
18463
18464res.hdrs : string
18465 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18466 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18467 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18468 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18469 based expect rules.
18470
18471res.hdrs_bin : binary
18472 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18473 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18474 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18475 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18476 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18477 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18478 (length of 0 for both).
18479
18480 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18481
18482 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18483 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018485res.ver : string
18486resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18487 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018488 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18489 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491 ACL derivatives :
18492 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18496 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018497 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018498 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18501 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503status : integer
18504 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18505 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018506 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18507 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018508
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018509unique-id : string
18510 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18511 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18512 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18513 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18514 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18515 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018517url : string
18518 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18519 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18520 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18521 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18522 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18523 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18524 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526 ACL derivatives :
18527 url : exact string match
18528 url_beg : prefix match
18529 url_dir : subdir match
18530 url_dom : domain match
18531 url_end : suffix match
18532 url_len : length match
18533 url_reg : regex match
18534 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536url_ip : ip
18537 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18538 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18539 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18540 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18541 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18542 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18543 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545url_port : integer
18546 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18547 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18548 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18549 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018550
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018551urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18552url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018553 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18554 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018555 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18556 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18557 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18558 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18560 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018561 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18562 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564 ACL derivatives :
18565 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18566 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18567 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18568 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18569 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18570 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18571 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18572 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018573
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575 Example :
18576 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18577 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18578 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18579 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018580
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018581urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018582 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18583 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18584 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018585
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018586url32 : integer
18587 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18588 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18589 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18590 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18591 is an unsigned integer.
18592
18593url32+src : binary
18594 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18595 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18596 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18597
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018598
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200185997.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018600---------------------------------------
18601
18602This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18603used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18604purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18605There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18606or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18607any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18608for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18609
18610internal.htx.data : integer
18611 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18612 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18613
18614internal.htx.free : integer
18615 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18616 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18617
18618internal.htx.free_data : integer
18619 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18620 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18621
18622internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18623 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18624 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18625 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18626
18627internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18628 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18629 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18630
18631internal.htx.size : integer
18632 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18633 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18634
18635internal.htx.used : integer
18636 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18637 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18638 direction.
18639
18640internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18641 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18642 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18643 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18644 of the special value :
18645 * head : The oldest inserted block
18646 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018647 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018648
18649internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18650 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18651 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18652 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18653 integer or one of the special value :
18654 * head : The oldest inserted block
18655 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018656 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018657
18658internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18659 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18660 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18661 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18662 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18663
18664 * head : The oldest inserted block
18665 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018666 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018667
18668internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18669 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18670 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18671 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18672 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18673
18674 * head : The oldest inserted block
18675 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018676 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018677
18678internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18679 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18680 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18681 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18682 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18683
18684 * head : The oldest inserted block
18685 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018686 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018687
18688internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18689 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18690 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18691 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18692 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18693
18694 * head : The oldest inserted block
18695 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018696 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018697
18698internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18699 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18700 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18701 it returns false.
18702
18703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200187047.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018705---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018707Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18708every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018709order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018711ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18712---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018713FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018714HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018715HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18716HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018717HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18718HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18719HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18720HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18721LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018722METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018723METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018724METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18725METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18726METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18727METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018728METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018729METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018730RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018731REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018732TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018733WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18734---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018735
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187378. Logging
18738----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018740One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18741provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18742very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18743provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18744state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018745to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018746headers.
18747
18748In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18749about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18750send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18751
18752 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18753 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18754 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18755 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18756 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018757 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018758 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018759
18760The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18761allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18762as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18763while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18764real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18765delay.
18766
18767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187688.1. Log levels
18769---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018770
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018771TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018772source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018773HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18774in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18775track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18776syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18777about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018778
18779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187808.2. Log formats
18781----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018782
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018783HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018784and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18785slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18786options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018787
18788 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18789 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18790 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18791 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18792 extents.
18793
18794 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18795 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18796 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18797 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18798 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18799
18800 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18801 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18802 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18803 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18804 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18805
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018806 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18807 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18808 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18809 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18810
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018811 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18812
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018813Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18814specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18815field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18816servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18817always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18818identifier.
18819
18820Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18821 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18822 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18823 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18824 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18825
18826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188278.2.1. Default log format
18828-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018829
18830This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18831as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18832format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18833
18834 Example :
18835 listen www
18836 mode http
18837 log global
18838 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18839
18840 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18841 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18842 (www/HTTP)
18843
18844 Field Format Extract from the example above
18845 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18846 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18847 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18848 4 'to' to
18849 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18850 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18851
18852Detailed fields description :
18853 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18854 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18855 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18856 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18857 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18858 and processed the connection.
18859 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18860
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018861In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18862"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18863connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18864
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018865It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18866will eventually disappear.
18867
18868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188698.2.2. TCP log format
18870---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018871
18872The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18873is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18874information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18875counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18876emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18877environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18878the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18879sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018880specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18881not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18882fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18883marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018884
18885 Example :
18886 frontend fnt
18887 mode tcp
18888 option tcplog
18889 log global
18890 default_backend bck
18891
18892 backend bck
18893 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18894
18895 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18896 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18897 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18898
18899 Field Format Extract from the example above
18900 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18901 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18902 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18903 4 frontend_name fnt
18904 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18905 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18906 7 bytes_read* 212
18907 8 termination_state --
18908 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18909 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18910
18911Detailed fields description :
18912 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018913 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18914 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18915 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018916 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018917 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018918 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018919
18920 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018921 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18922 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18923 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924
18925 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18926 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18927 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018928 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18929 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18930 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18931 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018932
18933 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18934 and processed the connection.
18935
18936 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18937 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18938 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18939 applications.
18940
18941 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18942 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18943 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18944 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18945 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18946
18947 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18948 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18949 See "Timers" below for more details.
18950
18951 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18952 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18953 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18954 "Timers" below for more details.
18955
18956 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018957 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018958 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18959 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18960 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18961 details.
18962
18963 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18964 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18965 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18966 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18967 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18968
18969 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18970 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18971 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18972 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18973 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18974 for more details.
18975
18976 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018977 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018978 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18979 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18980 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018981 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018982
18983 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18984 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18985 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18986 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18987 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18988 caused by a denial of service attack.
18989
18990 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18991 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18992 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18993 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18994 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18995 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18996 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18997 denial of service attack.
18998
18999 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19000 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19001 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19002 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19003 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19004 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19005 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19006 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19007 be processed than on other servers.
19008
19009 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19010 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19011 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19012 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19013 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19014 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19015 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19016 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19017 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19018 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19019 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19020 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19021 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19022
19023 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19024 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19025 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19026 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19027 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19028 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019029 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019030 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19031
19032 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19033 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19034 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19035 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19036 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19037 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019038 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19040 occurs.
19041
19042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190438.2.3. HTTP log format
19044----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019045
19046The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19047is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19048the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19049are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19050emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19051generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19052"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19053which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019054frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19055is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019056
19057Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19058slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19059with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19060
19061 Example :
19062 frontend http-in
19063 mode http
19064 option httplog
19065 log global
19066 default_backend bck
19067
19068 backend static
19069 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19070
19071 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19072 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19073 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019074 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019075
19076 Field Format Extract from the example above
19077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19078 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019079 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019080 4 frontend_name http-in
19081 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019082 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019083 7 status_code 200
19084 8 bytes_read* 2750
19085 9 captured_request_cookie -
19086 10 captured_response_cookie -
19087 11 termination_state ----
19088 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19089 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19090 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19091 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19092 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019093
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019094Detailed fields description :
19095 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019096 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19097 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19098 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019099 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019100 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019101 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019102
19103 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019104 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19105 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19106 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019107
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019108 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19109 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019110
19111 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19112 and processed the connection.
19113
19114 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19115 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19116 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19117
19118 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19119 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19120 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19121 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19122 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19123 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19124
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019125 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19126 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19127 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019128 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019129 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19130 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019131 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19132 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019133
19134 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19135 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019136 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019137
19138 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19139 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019140 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19141 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019142
19143 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19144 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19145 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19146 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19147 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019148 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19149 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019151 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19152 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19153 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19154 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19155 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19156 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19157 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019158 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019159
19160 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19161 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19162 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19163
19164 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19165 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019166 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019167 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19168 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19169 overflowing.
19170
19171 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19172 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19173 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19174 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19175 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19176 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19177 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19178 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19179
19180 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19181 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19182 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19183 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19184 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19185 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19186 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19187 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19188
19189 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19190 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19191 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19192 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19193 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19194 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19195 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19196
19197 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019198 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019199 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19200 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19201 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019202 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019203 system.
19204
19205 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19206 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19207 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19208 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19209 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19210 caused by a denial of service attack.
19211
19212 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19213 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19214 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19215 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19216 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19217 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19218 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19219 denial of service attack.
19220
19221 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19222 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19223 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19224 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19225 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19226 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19227 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19228 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19229 processed than on other servers.
19230
19231 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19232 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19233 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19234 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19235 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19236 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19237 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19238 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19239 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19240 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19241 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19242 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19243 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19244
19245 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19246 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19247 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19248 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19249 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19250 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019251 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019252 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19253
19254 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19255 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19256 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19257 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19258 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19259 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019260 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019261 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19262 occurs.
19263
19264 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19265 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19266 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19267 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19268 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19269 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19270 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19271 cookies" below for more details.
19272
19273 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19274 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19275 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19276 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19277 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19278 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19279 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19280 and cookies" below for more details.
19281
19282 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19283 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19284 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19285 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19286 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19287 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19288 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19289 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19290
19291
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200192928.2.4. Custom log format
19293------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019294
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019295The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019296mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019297
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019298HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019299Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19300separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19301prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19302
19303Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19304variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019305("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019306
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019307If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019308as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019309less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19310the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19311
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019312Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19313"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19314delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19315preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019316
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019317Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19318'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19319https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19320such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19321
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019322Flags are :
19323 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019324 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019325 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19326 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019327
19328 Example:
19329
19330 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19331 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19332
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019333 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19334
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019335At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19336
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019337 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19338 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019339
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019340the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019341
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019342 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19343 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19344 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019345
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019346and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19347
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019348 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19349 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019350
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019351Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19352
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019353 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019354 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019355 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19356 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19357 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019358 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19359 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19360 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019361 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019362 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19363 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019364 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019365 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19366 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019367 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019368 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019369 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019370 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019371 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019372 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019373 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019374 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19375 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19376 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19377 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19378 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019379 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019380 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019381 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019382 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019383 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019384 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19385 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019386 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19387 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19388 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019389 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019390 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19391 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019392 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019393 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19394 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19395 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019396 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019397 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019398 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19399 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19400 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19401 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019402 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019403 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019404 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019405 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019406 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019407 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019408 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19409 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19410 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019411 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019412 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19413 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019414 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019415 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19416 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019417 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019418 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019419 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019420 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019421
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019422 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019423
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019424
194258.2.5. Error log format
19426-----------------------
19427
19428When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19429protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19430By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19431"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019432will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019433logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19434
19435The format looks like this :
19436
19437 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19438 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19439 Connection error during SSL handshake
19440
19441 Field Format Extract from the example above
19442 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19443 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19444 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19445 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19446 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19447
19448These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19449failures.
19450
19451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194528.3. Advanced logging options
19453-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019454
19455Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19456just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19457options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19458for more information about their usage.
19459
19460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194618.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19462------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019463
19464It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19465haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19466commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19467monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19468ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19469
19470 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19471 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19472 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19473 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19474
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019475 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19476 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019477
19478 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19479 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19480 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19481
19482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194838.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19484----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019485
19486The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19487what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19488or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019489"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019490just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19491log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19492after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19493is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19494with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19495with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19496
19497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19499------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019500
19501Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19502for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19503"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19504retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19505raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19506a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19507file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19508you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19509"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19510
19511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195128.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19513--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019514
19515Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19516multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19517them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19518"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19519logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19520error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19521and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19522too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19523useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19524alternative.
19525
19526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195278.4. Timing events
19528------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019529
19530Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19531reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19532the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19533frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019534mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19535addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19536
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019537Timings events in HTTP mode:
19538
19539 first request 2nd request
19540 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19541 t tr t tr ...
19542 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19543 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19544 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19545 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019546 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019547 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19548
19549Timings events in TCP mode:
19550
19551 TCP session
19552 |<----------------->|
19553 t t
19554 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19555 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19556 |<------ Tt ------->|
19557
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019558 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019559 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019560 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19561 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19562 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019563 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019564 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19565 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19566 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19567 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019568
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019569 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19570 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19571 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019572 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19573 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19574 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19575 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19576 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19577 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019578
19579 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19580 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19581 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19582 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19583 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19584 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19585 request typed by hand during a test.
19586
19587 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19588 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019589 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019590 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19591 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19592 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19593 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019594
19595 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19596 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19597 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19598 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19599 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19600
19601 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19602 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19603 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19604 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19605 connection never established.
19606
19607 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19608 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19609 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19610 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19611 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19612 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19613 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19614 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19615 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19616 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19617 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19618
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019619 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19620 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19621 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19622 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19623 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19624 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19625
19626 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19627
19628 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19629 "Ta" can never be negative.
19630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019631 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19632 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019633 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19634 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019635 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019637 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019638
19639 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019640 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19641 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019642
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019643 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19644 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19645 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19646 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19647 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19648 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19649 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19650 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19651
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019652These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19653protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19654that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019655due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19656"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19657that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019658
19659Most common cases :
19660
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019661 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19662 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19663 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19664 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19665 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19666 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19667 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19668 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19669 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19670 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19671 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019672 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019673
19674 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19675 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19676 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19677 of ms on remote networks.
19678
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019679 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19680 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19681 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019683 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19684 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19685 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19686 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19687 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19688 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19689 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19690 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19691 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019692
19693Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19694
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019695 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019696 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019697 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019698
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019699 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19701 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19702
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019703 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019704 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19705 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19706 flags.
19707
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019708 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19709 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019710 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19711 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19712 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19713 the client connection was maintained open.
19714
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019715 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019716 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019717 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019718 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19719
19720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197218.5. Session state at disconnection
19722-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019723
19724TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19725"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
197262-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19727each of which has a special meaning :
19728
19729 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19730 session to terminate :
19731
19732 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19733
19734 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19735 server explicitly refused it.
19736
19737 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19738 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19739 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19740 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019741 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019742
19743 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19744 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019745
19746 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19747 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19748 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19749 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19750 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19751
19752 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19753 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19754 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19755 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19756 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19757
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019758 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19759 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19760
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019761 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19762 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19763 backup connections when going up.
19764
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019765 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19766
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019767 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19768 send or receive data.
19769
19770 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19771 send or receive data.
19772
19773 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19774 with nothing left in the buffers.
19775
19776 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19777
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019778 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019779 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19780
19781 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19782 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19783 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19784 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19785 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19786
19787 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19788 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19789
19790 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19791 server (HTTP only).
19792
19793 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19794
19795 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19796 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19797 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19798
19799 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19800 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19801 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19802
19803 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19804
19805 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19806 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19807
19808 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19809 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19810 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19811
19812 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19813 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019814 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19815 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019816
19817 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19818 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19819 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19820 another server.
19821
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019822 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019823 server.
19824
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019825 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19826 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19827 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19828 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19829
19830 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19831 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19832 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19833 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19834
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019835 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19836 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19837 "use-server" rule).
19838
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019839 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19840
19841 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19842 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19843
19844 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19845
19846 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19847 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19848 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19849
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019850 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19851 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019852 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019853 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19854 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019856 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19857
19858 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19859 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19860
19861 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19862
19863 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19864
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019865The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19866was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019867helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19868starvation, attacks, etc...
19869
19870The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19871alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19872easier finding and understanding.
19873
19874 Flags Reason
19875
19876 -- Normal termination.
19877
19878 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19879 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19880 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19881 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19882
19883 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19884 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19885 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19886 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19887 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19888 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019890 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19891 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019892 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019893
19894 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19895 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19896 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19897
19898 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19899 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19900 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19901 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19902 the server takes too long to respond.
19903
19904 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19905 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19906 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19907 long a time to respond.
19908
19909 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19910 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19911 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19912 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019913 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19914 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915
19916 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19917 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19918 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19919 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19920 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019921 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019922 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19923 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19924 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19925 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19926 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19927 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19928 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19929 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019930 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019931 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19932 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19933 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019934
19935 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19936 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019937 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19938 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19939 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19940 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019941
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019942 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19943 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019945 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019946 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19947 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019948 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019949 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19950 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19951
19952 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19953 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19954 503 or 504 here.
19955
19956 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19957 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19958 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19959 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19960 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19961
19962 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19963 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019964 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19966 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19967
19968 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19969 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19970 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19971 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19972 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19973 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19974 between haproxy and the server.
19975
19976 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19977 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19978 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19979 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19980 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19981 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19982 solution is to fix the application.
19983
19984 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19985 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19986 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19987 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19988 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19989 external attacks.
19990
19991 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19992 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019993 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019994 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19995 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19996
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019997 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19998 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19999 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020000 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020001 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020002
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020003 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20004 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20005 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20006 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020007 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20008 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20009 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20010 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20011 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020012
20013 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20014 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20015 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20016 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20017
20018 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20019 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20020 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20021 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20022
20023 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20024 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20025 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20026 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20027
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020028The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20029persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20030important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20031re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20032
20033 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20034
20035 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20036 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20037 set on a GET request.
20038
20039 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20040 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020041 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020042 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20043
20044 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20045 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20046 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20047
20048 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20049 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20050 already got a cookie.
20051
20052 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20053 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20054 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20055 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20056 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20057
20058 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20059 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20060 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20061
20062 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20063 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20064 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20065
20066 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20067 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20068
20069 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20070 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20071 then advertised in the response.
20072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200748.6. Non-printable characters
20075-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020076
20077In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20078consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20079converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20080prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20081being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20082escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20083is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20084'}' when logging headers.
20085
20086Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20087issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20088containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20089
20090Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20091the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20092performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20093
20094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20096---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020097
20098Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20099achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020100section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020101cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20102the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20103the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020104locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020105not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20106user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20107a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20108wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20109
20110 Examples :
20111 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20112 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20113
20114 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20115 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20116
20117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201188.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20119---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120
20121Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20122proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20123the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20124server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20125
20126Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20127response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020128section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020129
20130It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020131time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20132appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020133are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20134and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20135follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20136request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20137in the logs.
20138
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020139As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20140frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20141an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020143 Example :
20144 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20145 listen proxy-out
20146 mode http
20147 option httplog
20148 option logasap
20149 log global
20150 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20151
20152 # log the name of the virtual server
20153 capture request header Host len 20
20154
20155 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20156 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20157
20158 # log the beginning of the referrer
20159 capture request header Referer len 20
20160
20161 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20162 capture response header Server len 20
20163
20164 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20165 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20166
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020167 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020168 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20169
20170 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20171 capture response header Via len 20
20172
20173 # log the URL location during a redirection
20174 capture response header Location len 20
20175
20176 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20177 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20178 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20179 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20180 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20181
20182 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20183 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20184 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20185 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020186 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020187
20188 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20189 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20190 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20191 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20192 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020193 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020194
20195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201968.9. Examples of logs
20197---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198
20199These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20200them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20201reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20202
20203 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20204 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20205 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20206
20207 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20208 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20209
20210 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20211 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20212 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20213
20214 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20215 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20216
20217 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20218 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20219 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20220
20221 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020222 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20224 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20225
20226 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20227 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20228 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20229
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020230 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20231 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20232 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20233 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20234 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20235 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
20237 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020238 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020239
20240 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20241 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20242 Nothing was sent to any server.
20243
20244 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20245 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20246
20247 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20248 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020249 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020250 send a 408 return code to the client.
20251
20252 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20253 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20254
20255 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20256 5 seconds ("c----").
20257
20258 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20259 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020260 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020261
20262 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020263 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20265 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20266 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20267 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20268 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020269
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020270
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200202719. Supported filters
20272--------------------
20273
20274Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20275accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20276unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20277
20278See also : "filter"
20279
202809.1. Trace
20281----------
20282
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020283filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020284
20285 Arguments:
20286 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20287 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20288
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020289 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020290
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020291 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020292 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20293 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20294 amount of the parsed data.
20295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020296 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020297
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020298This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20299callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20300information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20301filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20302
20303Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20304tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20305a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20306
20307
203089.2. HTTP compression
20309---------------------
20310
20311filter compression
20312
20313The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20314keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020315when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20316fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20317done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20318explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20319filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20320listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20321order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020322
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020323See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20324 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020325
20326
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200203279.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20328--------------------------------------------
20329
20330filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20331
20332 Arguments :
20333
20334 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20335 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20336 parsed.
20337
20338 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20339 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20340 part must be placed in its own scope.
20341
20342The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20343external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020344streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020345exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20346also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20347
20348SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20349the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20350
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020351For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020352"doc/SPOE.txt".
20353
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100203549.4. Cache
20355----------
20356
20357filter cache <name>
20358
20359 Arguments :
20360
20361 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20362
20363The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20364"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020365cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020366other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20367case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20368is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20369filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020370listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20371order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020372
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020373See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20374 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20375
20376
203779.5. Fcgi-app
20378-------------
20379
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020380filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020381
20382 Arguments :
20383
20384 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20385
20386The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20387request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20388reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20389used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20390implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20391used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20392fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20393used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20394order.
20395
20396See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20397 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20398
20399
2040010. FastCGI applications
20401-------------------------
20402
20403HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20404feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20405the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20406FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20407servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20408FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20409backend.
20410
20411HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20412application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20413connection.
20414
2041510.1. Setup
20416-----------
20417
2041810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20419--------------------------
20420
20421fcgi-app <name>
20422 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20423 document root must be defined.
20424
20425acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20426 Declare or complete an access list.
20427
20428 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20429 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20430 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20431 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20432 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20433
20434docroot <path>
20435 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20436 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20437 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20438
20439index <script-name>
20440 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20441 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20442 is an optional setting.
20443
20444 Example :
20445 index index.php
20446
20447log-stderr global
20448log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20449 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20450 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20451
20452 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20453 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20454
20455pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20456 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20457 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20458 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20459
20460 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20461 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20462 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20463 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20464
20465 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20466 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20467
20468path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020469 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020470 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20471 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20472 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20473 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20474 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20475 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20476 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020477
20478 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020479 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020480 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20481 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20482 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20483 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020484
20485 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020486 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20487 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020488
20489option get-values
20490no option get-values
20491 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20492
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020493 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020494 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20495
20496 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20497 application will accept.
20498
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020499 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20500 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020501
20502 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020503 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020504 option is disabled.
20505
20506 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20507 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20508 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20509 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20510 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20511 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20512
20513option keep-conn
20514no option keep-conn
20515 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20516 sending a response.
20517
20518 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20519 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20520
20521option max-reqs <reqs>
20522 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20523 accept.
20524
20525 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20526 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20527 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20528 to 1.
20529
20530option mpxs-conns
20531no option mpxs-conns
20532 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20533
20534 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20535 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20536
20537set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20538 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20539 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20540 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20541 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20542
20543 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20544 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20545 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20546
20547 Example :
20548 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20549 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20550
20551 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20552
20553
2055410.1.2. Proxy section
20555---------------------
20556
20557use-fcgi-app <name>
20558 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20559
20560 Arguments :
20561 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20562
20563 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20564 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20565 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20566 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20567 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20568
20569 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20570 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20571 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20572 application are evaluated.
20573
20574
2057510.1.3. Example
20576---------------
20577
20578 frontend front-http
20579 mode http
20580 bind *:80
20581 bind *:
20582
20583 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20584 default_backend back-static
20585
20586 backend back-static
20587 mode http
20588 server www A.B.C.D:80
20589
20590 backend back-dynamic
20591 mode http
20592 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20593 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20594
20595 fcgi-app php-fpm
20596 log-stderr global
20597 option keep-conn
20598
20599 docroot /var/www/my-app
20600 index index.php
20601 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20602
20603
2060410.2. Default parameters
20605------------------------
20606
20607A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20608the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020609script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020610applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20611
20612 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20613 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20614 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20615 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20616 | | |
20617 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20618 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20619 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20620 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20621 | | application. |
20622 | | |
20623 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20624 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20625 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20626 | | |
20627 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20628 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20629 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20630 | | the application's configuration. |
20631 | | |
20632 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20633 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20634 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20635 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20636 | | |
20637 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20638 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20639 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20640 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20641 | | be defined. |
20642 | | |
20643 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20644 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20645 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20646 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20647 | | is not set too. |
20648 | | |
20649 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20650 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20651 | | set. |
20652 | | |
20653 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20654 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20655 | | the request. |
20656 | | |
20657 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20658 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20659 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20660 | | |
20661 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20662 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20663 | | script to process the request. |
20664 | | |
20665 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20666 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20667 | | |
20668 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20669 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20670 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20671 | | |
20672 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20673 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20674 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20675 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20676 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20677 | | |
20678 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20679 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20680 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20681 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20682 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20683 | | side. |
20684 | | |
20685 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20686 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20687 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20688 | | connected to. |
20689 | | |
20690 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20691 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20692 | | |
20693 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20694 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20695 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20696 | | |
20697 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20698
20699
2070010.3. Limitations
20701------------------
20702
20703The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20704way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20705during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20706establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20707application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20708or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20709message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20710these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20711and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20712
20713Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20714request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20715requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20716
20717About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20718into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20719fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20720"http-request" ones.
20721
20722Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20723FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20724processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20725must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20726here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020728/*
20729 * Local variables:
20730 * fill-column: 79
20731 * End:
20732 */